1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2020 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
14 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
15 #include <linux/list.h>
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/netlink.h>
18 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
19 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
20 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
21 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
22 #include <linux/net.h>
23 #include <net/regulatory.h>
24 
25 /**
26  * DOC: Introduction
27  *
28  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
29  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
30  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
31  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
32  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
33  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
34  *
35  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
36  * use restrictions.
37  */
38 
39 
40 /**
41  * DOC: Device registration
42  *
43  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
44  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
45  * described below.
46  *
47  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
48  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
49  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
50  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
51  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
52  * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
53  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
54  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
55  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
56  *
57  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
58  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
59  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
60  */
61 
62 struct wiphy;
63 
64 /*
65  * wireless hardware capability structures
66  */
67 
68 /**
69  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
70  *
71  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
72  *
73  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
74  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
75  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
78  *	is not permitted.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
80  *	is not permitted.
81  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
83  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
84  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
85  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
86  *	restrictions.
87  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
88  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
89  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91  *	restrictions.
92  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
93  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
94  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
95  *	on this channel.
96  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
97  *	on this channel.
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
102  *	on this channel.
103  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
104  *	on this channel.
105  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
106  *	on this channel.
107  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
108  *	on this channel.
109  *
110  */
111 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
112 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
113 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
114 	/* hole at 1<<2 */
115 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
116 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
117 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
118 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
119 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
120 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
121 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
122 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
123 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
124 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
125 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
126 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
127 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
128 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
129 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
131 };
132 
133 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
134 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
135 
136 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
137 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
138 
139 /**
140  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
141  *
142  * This structure describes a single channel for use
143  * with cfg80211.
144  *
145  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
146  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
147  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
148  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
149  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
150  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
151  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
152  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
153  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
154  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
155  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
156  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
157  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
158  * @orig_mag: internal use
159  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
160  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
161  *	on this channel.
162  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
163  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
164  */
165 struct ieee80211_channel {
166 	enum nl80211_band band;
167 	u32 center_freq;
168 	u16 freq_offset;
169 	u16 hw_value;
170 	u32 flags;
171 	int max_antenna_gain;
172 	int max_power;
173 	int max_reg_power;
174 	bool beacon_found;
175 	u32 orig_flags;
176 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
177 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
178 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
179 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
180 };
181 
182 /**
183  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
184  *
185  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
186  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
187  * different bands/PHY modes.
188  *
189  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
190  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
191  *	with CCK rates.
192  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
193  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
194  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
195  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
196  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
197  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
198  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
199  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
200  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
201  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
202  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
203  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
204  */
205 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
206 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
207 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
208 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
209 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
210 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
211 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
212 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
213 };
214 
215 /**
216  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
217  *
218  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
219  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
220  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
221  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
222  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
223  */
224 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
225 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
226 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
227 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
228 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
229 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
230 };
231 
232 /**
233  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
234  *
235  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
236  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
237  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
238  */
239 enum ieee80211_privacy {
240 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
241 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
242 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
243 };
244 
245 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
246 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
247 
248 /**
249  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
250  *
251  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
252  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
253  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
254  * passed around.
255  *
256  * @flags: rate-specific flags
257  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
258  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
259  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
260  *	short preamble is used
261  */
262 struct ieee80211_rate {
263 	u32 flags;
264 	u16 bitrate;
265 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
266 };
267 
268 /**
269  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
270  *
271  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
272  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
273  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
274  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
275  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
276  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
277  *	members of the SRG
278  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
279  *	used by members of the SRG
280  */
281 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
282 	bool enable;
283 	u8 sr_ctrl;
284 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
285 	u8 min_offset;
286 	u8 max_offset;
287 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
288 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
289 };
290 
291 /**
292  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
293  *
294  * @color: the current color.
295  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
296  * @partial: define the AID equation.
297  */
298 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
299 	u8 color;
300 	bool enabled;
301 	bool partial;
302 };
303 
304 /**
305  * struct ieee80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
306  *
307  * @color: the current color.
308  * @disabled: is the feature disabled.
309  * @partial: define the AID equation.
310  */
311 struct ieee80211_he_bss_color {
312 	u8 color;
313 	bool disabled;
314 	bool partial;
315 };
316 
317 /**
318  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
319  *
320  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
321  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
322  *
323  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
324  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
325  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
326  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
327  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
328  */
329 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
330 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
331 	bool ht_supported;
332 	u8 ampdu_factor;
333 	u8 ampdu_density;
334 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
335 };
336 
337 /**
338  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
339  *
340  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
341  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
342  *
343  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
344  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
345  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
346  */
347 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
348 	bool vht_supported;
349 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
350 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
351 };
352 
353 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
354 
355 /**
356  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
357  *
358  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
359  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
360  *
361  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
362  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
363  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
364  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
365  */
366 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
367 	bool has_he;
368 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
369 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
370 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
371 };
372 
373 /**
374  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data
375  *
376  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
377  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
378  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
379  *
380  * @types_mask: interface types mask
381  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
382  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
383  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
384  */
385 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
386 	u16 types_mask;
387 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
388 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
389 };
390 
391 /**
392  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
393  *
394  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
395  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
396  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
397  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
398  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
399  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
400  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
401  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
402  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
403  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
404  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
405  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
406  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
407  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
408  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
409  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
410  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
411  */
412 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
413 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
414 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
415 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
416 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
417 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
418 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
419 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
420 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
421 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
422 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
423 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
424 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
425 };
426 
427 /**
428  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
429  *
430  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
431  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
432  *
433  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
434  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
435  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
436  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
437  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
438  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
439  */
440 struct ieee80211_edmg {
441 	u8 channels;
442 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
443 };
444 
445 /**
446  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
447  *
448  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
449  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
450  *
451  * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA
452  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
453  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
454  */
455 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
456 	bool s1g;
457 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
458 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
459 };
460 
461 /**
462  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
463  *
464  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
465  * is able to operate in.
466  *
467  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
468  *	in this band.
469  * @band: the band this structure represents
470  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
471  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
472  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
473  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
474  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
475  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
476  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
477  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
478  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
479  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
480  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
481  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
482  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
483  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
484  *	iftype_data).
485  */
486 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
487 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
488 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
489 	enum nl80211_band band;
490 	int n_channels;
491 	int n_bitrates;
492 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
493 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
494 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
495 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
496 	u16 n_iftype_data;
497 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data;
498 };
499 
500 /**
501  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
502  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
503  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
504  *
505  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
506  */
507 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)508 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
509 				u8 iftype)
510 {
511 	int i;
512 
513 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
514 		return NULL;
515 
516 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++)  {
517 		const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
518 			&sband->iftype_data[i];
519 
520 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
521 			return data;
522 	}
523 
524 	return NULL;
525 }
526 
527 /**
528  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
529  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
530  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
531  *
532  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
533  */
534 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)535 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
536 			    u8 iftype)
537 {
538 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
539 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
540 
541 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
542 		return &data->he_cap;
543 
544 	return NULL;
545 }
546 
547 /**
548  * ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's STA
549  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
550  *
551  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
552  */
553 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband)554 ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband)
555 {
556 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION);
557 }
558 
559 /**
560  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
561  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
562  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
563  *
564  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
565  */
566 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)567 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
568 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
569 {
570 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
571 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
572 
573 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
574 		return 0;
575 
576 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
577 }
578 
579 /**
580  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
581  *
582  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
583  *
584  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
585  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
586  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
587  *
588  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
589  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
590  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
591  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
592  * without affecting other devices.
593  *
594  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
595  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
596  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
597  */
598 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
599 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
600 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)601 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
602 {
603 }
604 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
605 
606 
607 /*
608  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
609  */
610 
611 /**
612  * DOC: Actions and configuration
613  *
614  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
615  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
616  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
617  * operations use are described separately.
618  *
619  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
620  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
621  *
622  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
623  * in a separate chapter.
624  */
625 
626 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
627 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
628 
629 /**
630  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
631  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
632  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
633  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
634  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
635  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
636  *	determine the address as needed.
637  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
638  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
639  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
640  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
641  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
642  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
643  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
644  */
645 struct vif_params {
646 	u32 flags;
647 	int use_4addr;
648 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
649 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
650 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
651 };
652 
653 /**
654  * struct key_params - key information
655  *
656  * Information about a key
657  *
658  * @key: key material
659  * @key_len: length of key material
660  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
661  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
662  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
663  *	length given by @seq_len.
664  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
665  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
666  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
667  */
668 struct key_params {
669 	const u8 *key;
670 	const u8 *seq;
671 	int key_len;
672 	int seq_len;
673 	u16 vlan_id;
674 	u32 cipher;
675 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
676 };
677 
678 /**
679  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
680  * @chan: the (control) channel
681  * @width: channel width
682  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
683  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
684  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
685  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
686  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
687  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
688  *	parameters are ignored.
689  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
690  */
691 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
692 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
693 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
694 	u32 center_freq1;
695 	u32 center_freq2;
696 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
697 	u16 freq1_offset;
698 };
699 
700 /*
701  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
702  */
703 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
704 	struct {
705 		u32 legacy;
706 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
707 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
708 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
709 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
710 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
711 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
712 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
713 };
714 
715 
716 /**
717  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
718  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
719  *	of the peer.
720  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
721  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
722  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
723  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
724  * @retry_long: retry count value
725  * @retry_short: retry count value
726  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
727  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
728  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
729  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
730  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
731  */
732 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
733 	bool config_override;
734 	u8 tids;
735 	u64 mask;
736 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
737 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
738 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
739 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
740 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
741 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
742 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
743 };
744 
745 /**
746  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
747  * @peer: Station's MAC address
748  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
749  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
750  */
751 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
752 	const u8 *peer;
753 	u32 n_tid_conf;
754 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[];
755 };
756 
757 /**
758  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
759  * @chandef: the channel definition
760  *
761  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
762  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
763  */
764 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)765 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
766 {
767 	switch (chandef->width) {
768 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
769 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
770 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
771 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
772 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
773 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
774 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
775 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
776 	default:
777 		WARN_ON(1);
778 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
779 	}
780 }
781 
782 /**
783  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
784  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
785  * @channel: the control channel
786  * @chantype: the channel type
787  *
788  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
789  */
790 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
791 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
792 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
793 
794 /**
795  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
796  * @chandef1: first channel definition
797  * @chandef2: second channel definition
798  *
799  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
800  * identical, %false otherwise.
801  */
802 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)803 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
804 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
805 {
806 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
807 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
808 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
809 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
810 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
811 }
812 
813 /**
814  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
815  *
816  * @chandef: the channel definition
817  *
818  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
819  */
820 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)821 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
822 {
823 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
824 }
825 
826 /**
827  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
828  * @chandef1: first channel definition
829  * @chandef2: second channel definition
830  *
831  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
832  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
833  */
834 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
835 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
836 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
837 
838 /**
839  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
840  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
841  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
842  */
843 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
844 
845 /**
846  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
847  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
848  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
849  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
850  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
851  */
852 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
853 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
854 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
855 
856 /**
857  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
858  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
859  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
860  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
861  * Returns:
862  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
863  */
864 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
865 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
866 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
867 
868 /**
869  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
870  *
871  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
872  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
873  *
874  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
875  *
876  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
877  */
878 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)879 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
880 {
881 	switch (chandef->width) {
882 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
883 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
884 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
885 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
886 	default:
887 		break;
888 	}
889 	return 0;
890 }
891 
892 /**
893  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
894  *
895  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
896  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
897  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
898  *
899  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
900  *
901  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
902  */
903 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)904 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
905 {
906 	switch (chandef->width) {
907 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
908 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
909 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
910 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
911 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
912 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
913 	default:
914 		break;
915 	}
916 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
917 }
918 
919 /**
920  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
921  *
922  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
923  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
924  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
925  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
926  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
927  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
928  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
929  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
930  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
931  *
932  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
933  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
934  */
935 enum survey_info_flags {
936 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
937 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
938 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
939 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
940 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
941 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
942 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
943 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
944 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
945 };
946 
947 /**
948  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
949  *
950  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
951  *	record to report global statistics
952  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
953  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
954  *	optional
955  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
956  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
957  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
958  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
959  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
960  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
961  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
962  *
963  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
964  *
965  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
966  * channel duty cycle etc.
967  */
968 struct survey_info {
969 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
970 	u64 time;
971 	u64 time_busy;
972 	u64 time_ext_busy;
973 	u64 time_rx;
974 	u64 time_tx;
975 	u64 time_scan;
976 	u64 time_bss_rx;
977 	u32 filled;
978 	s8 noise;
979 };
980 
981 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS	4
982 
983 /**
984  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
985  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
986  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
987  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
988  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
989  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
990  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
991  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
992  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
993  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
994  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
995  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
996  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
997  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
998  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
999  *	protocol frames.
1000  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1001  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1002  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1003  *	port for mac80211
1004  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
1005  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
1006  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
1007  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1008  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1009  *	offload)
1010  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1011  */
1012 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1013 	u32 wpa_versions;
1014 	u32 cipher_group;
1015 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1016 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1017 	int n_akm_suites;
1018 	u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES];
1019 	bool control_port;
1020 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1021 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1022 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1023 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1024 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
1025 	int wep_tx_key;
1026 	const u8 *psk;
1027 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1028 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1029 };
1030 
1031 /**
1032  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1033  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1034  *	or %NULL if not changed
1035  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1036  *	or %NULL if not changed
1037  * @head_len: length of @head
1038  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1039  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1040  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1041  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1042  *	frames or %NULL
1043  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1044  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1045  *	Response frames or %NULL
1046  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1047  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1048  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1049  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1050  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1051  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1052  *	(measurement type 8)
1053  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1054  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1055  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1056  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1057  */
1058 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1059 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1060 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1061 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1062 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1063 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1064 	const u8 *lci;
1065 	const u8 *civicloc;
1066 	s8 ftm_responder;
1067 
1068 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1069 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1070 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1071 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1072 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1073 	size_t lci_len;
1074 	size_t civicloc_len;
1075 };
1076 
1077 struct mac_address {
1078 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1079 };
1080 
1081 /**
1082  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1083  *
1084  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1085  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1086  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1087  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1088  */
1089 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1090 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1091 	int n_acl_entries;
1092 
1093 	/* Keep it last */
1094 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[];
1095 };
1096 
1097 /**
1098  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1099  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1100  *
1101  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1102  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1103  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1104  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1105  *	frame headers.
1106  */
1107 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1108 	u32 min_interval;
1109 	u32 max_interval;
1110 	size_t tmpl_len;
1111 	const u8 *tmpl;
1112 };
1113 
1114 /**
1115  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1116  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1117  *
1118  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1119  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1120  *	scanning
1121  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1122  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1123  */
1124 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1125 	u32 interval;
1126 	size_t tmpl_len;
1127 	const u8 *tmpl;
1128 };
1129 
1130 /**
1131  * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
1132  *
1133  * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings
1134  *
1135  * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication
1136  */
1137 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags {
1138 	AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0),
1139 };
1140 
1141 /**
1142  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1143  *
1144  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1145  *
1146  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1147  * @beacon: beacon data
1148  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1149  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1150  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1151  *	user space)
1152  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1153  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1154  * @crypto: crypto settings
1155  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1156  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1157  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1158  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1159  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1160  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1161  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1162  *	MAC address based access control
1163  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1164  *	networks.
1165  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1166  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1167  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1168  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1169  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1170  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1171  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1172  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1173  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags
1174  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1175  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1176  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1177  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1178  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1179  */
1180 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1181 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1182 
1183 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1184 
1185 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1186 	const u8 *ssid;
1187 	size_t ssid_len;
1188 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1189 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1190 	bool privacy;
1191 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1192 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1193 	int inactivity_timeout;
1194 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1195 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1196 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1197 	bool pbss;
1198 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1199 
1200 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1201 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1202 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1203 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1204 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required;
1205 	bool twt_responder;
1206 	u32 flags;
1207 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1208 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1209 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1210 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1211 };
1212 
1213 /**
1214  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1215  *
1216  * Used for channel switch
1217  *
1218  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1219  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1220  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1221  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1222  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1223  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1224  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1225  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1226  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1227  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1228  */
1229 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1230 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1231 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1232 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1233 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1234 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1235 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1236 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1237 	bool radar_required;
1238 	bool block_tx;
1239 	u8 count;
1240 };
1241 
1242 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_DIFFERENT_CHANNELS 10
1243 
1244 /**
1245  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1246  *
1247  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1248  *
1249  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1250  *	to use for verification
1251  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1252  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1253  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1254  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1255  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1256  *	nl80211_iftype.
1257  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1258  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1259  *	the verification
1260  */
1261 struct iface_combination_params {
1262 	int num_different_channels;
1263 	u8 radar_detect;
1264 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1265 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1266 };
1267 
1268 /**
1269  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1270  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1271  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1272  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1273  *
1274  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1275  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1276  */
1277 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1278 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1279 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1280 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1281 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3),
1282 };
1283 
1284 /**
1285  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1286  *
1287  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1288  *
1289  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1290  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1291  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1292  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1293  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1294  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1295  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1296  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1297  *	per peer TPC.
1298  */
1299 struct sta_txpwr {
1300 	s16 power;
1301 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1302 };
1303 
1304 /**
1305  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1306  *
1307  * Used to change and create a new station.
1308  *
1309  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1310  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1311  *	(or NULL for no change)
1312  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1313  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1314  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1315  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1316  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1317  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1318  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1319  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1320  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1321  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1322  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1323  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1324  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1325  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1326  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1327  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1328  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1329  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1330  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1331  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1332  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1333  *	to unknown)
1334  * @capability: station capability
1335  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1336  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1337  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1338  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1339  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1340  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1341  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1342  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1343  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1344  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1345  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1346  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1347  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1348  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1349  */
1350 struct station_parameters {
1351 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1352 	struct net_device *vlan;
1353 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1354 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1355 	int listen_interval;
1356 	u16 aid;
1357 	u16 vlan_id;
1358 	u16 peer_aid;
1359 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1360 	u8 plink_action;
1361 	u8 plink_state;
1362 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1363 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1364 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1365 	u8 max_sp;
1366 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1367 	u16 capability;
1368 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1369 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1370 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1371 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1372 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1373 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1374 	u8 opmode_notif;
1375 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1376 	int support_p2p_ps;
1377 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1378 	u8 he_capa_len;
1379 	u16 airtime_weight;
1380 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1381 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1382 };
1383 
1384 /**
1385  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1386  *
1387  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1388  *
1389  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1390  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1391  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1392  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1393  */
1394 struct station_del_parameters {
1395 	const u8 *mac;
1396 	u8 subtype;
1397 	u16 reason_code;
1398 };
1399 
1400 /**
1401  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1402  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1403  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1404  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1405  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1406  *	the AP MLME in the device
1407  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1408  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1409  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1410  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1411  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1412  *	supported/used)
1413  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1414  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1415  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1416  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1417  */
1418 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1419 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1420 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1421 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1422 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1423 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1424 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1425 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1426 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1427 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1428 };
1429 
1430 /**
1431  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1432  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1433  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1434  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1435  *
1436  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1437  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1438  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1439  * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1440  * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1441  */
1442 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1443 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1444 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1445 
1446 /**
1447  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1448  *
1449  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1450  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1451  *
1452  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1453  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1454  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1455  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1456  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1457  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1458  */
1459 enum rate_info_flags {
1460 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1461 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1462 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1463 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1464 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1465 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1466 };
1467 
1468 /**
1469  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1470  *
1471  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1472  *
1473  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1474  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1475  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1476  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1477  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1478  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1479  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1480  */
1481 enum rate_info_bw {
1482 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1483 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1484 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1485 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1486 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1487 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1488 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1489 };
1490 
1491 /**
1492  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1493  *
1494  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1495  *
1496  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1497  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate
1498  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1499  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1500  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1501  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1502  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1503  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1504  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1505  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1506  */
1507 struct rate_info {
1508 	u8 flags;
1509 	u8 mcs;
1510 	u16 legacy;
1511 	u8 nss;
1512 	u8 bw;
1513 	u8 he_gi;
1514 	u8 he_dcm;
1515 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1516 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1517 };
1518 
1519 /**
1520  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1521  *
1522  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1523  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1524  *
1525  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1526  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1527  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1528  */
1529 enum bss_param_flags {
1530 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1531 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1532 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1533 };
1534 
1535 /**
1536  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1537  *
1538  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1539  *
1540  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1541  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1542  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1543  */
1544 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1545 	u8 flags;
1546 	u8 dtim_period;
1547 	u16 beacon_interval;
1548 };
1549 
1550 /**
1551  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1552  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1553  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1554  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1555  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1556  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1557  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1558  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1559  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1560  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1561  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1562  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1563  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1564  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1565  */
1566 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1567 	u32 filled;
1568 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1569 	u32 backlog_packets;
1570 	u32 flows;
1571 	u32 drops;
1572 	u32 ecn_marks;
1573 	u32 overlimit;
1574 	u32 overmemory;
1575 	u32 collisions;
1576 	u32 tx_bytes;
1577 	u32 tx_packets;
1578 	u32 max_flows;
1579 };
1580 
1581 /**
1582  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1583  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1584  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1585  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1586  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1587  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1588  *	transmitted MSDUs
1589  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1590  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1591  */
1592 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1593 	u32 filled;
1594 	u64 rx_msdu;
1595 	u64 tx_msdu;
1596 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1597 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1598 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1599 };
1600 
1601 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
1602 
1603 /**
1604  * struct station_info - station information
1605  *
1606  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1607  *
1608  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1609  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1610  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1611  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1612  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1613  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1614  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1615  * @llid: mesh local link id
1616  * @plid: mesh peer link id
1617  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1618  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1619  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1620  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1621  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1622  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1623  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1624  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1625  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1626  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1627  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1628  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1629  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1630  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
1631  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
1632  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
1633  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1634  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
1635  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1636  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1637  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
1638  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
1639  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
1640  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
1641  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
1642  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
1643  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
1644  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
1645  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
1646  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
1647  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
1648  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
1649  *	towards this station.
1650  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
1651  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
1652  *	from this peer
1653  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
1654  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
1655  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
1656  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
1657  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
1658  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
1659  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
1660  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
1661  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
1662  *	been sent.
1663  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
1664  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
1665  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
1666  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
1667  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
1668  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
1669  */
1670 struct station_info {
1671 	u64 filled;
1672 	u32 connected_time;
1673 	u32 inactive_time;
1674 	u64 assoc_at;
1675 	u64 rx_bytes;
1676 	u64 tx_bytes;
1677 	u16 llid;
1678 	u16 plid;
1679 	u8 plink_state;
1680 	s8 signal;
1681 	s8 signal_avg;
1682 
1683 	u8 chains;
1684 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1685 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1686 
1687 	struct rate_info txrate;
1688 	struct rate_info rxrate;
1689 	u32 rx_packets;
1690 	u32 tx_packets;
1691 	u32 tx_retries;
1692 	u32 tx_failed;
1693 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
1694 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
1695 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
1696 
1697 	int generation;
1698 
1699 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
1700 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
1701 
1702 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
1703 	s64 t_offset;
1704 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1705 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
1706 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
1707 
1708 	u32 expected_throughput;
1709 
1710 	u64 tx_duration;
1711 	u64 rx_duration;
1712 	u64 rx_beacon;
1713 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
1714 	u8 connected_to_gate;
1715 
1716 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
1717 	s8 ack_signal;
1718 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
1719 
1720 	u16 airtime_weight;
1721 
1722 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
1723 	u32 fcs_err_count;
1724 
1725 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
1726 
1727 	u8 connected_to_as;
1728 };
1729 
1730 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
1731 /**
1732  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
1733  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
1734  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
1735  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
1736  *
1737  * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
1738  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
1739  * considered undefined.
1740  */
1741 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
1742 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
1743 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)1744 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
1745 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
1746 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
1747 {
1748 	return -ENOENT;
1749 }
1750 #endif
1751 
1752 /**
1753  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
1754  *
1755  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
1756  * according to the nl80211 flags.
1757  *
1758  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
1759  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
1760  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
1761  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
1762  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
1763  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
1764  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
1765  */
1766 enum monitor_flags {
1767 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
1768 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
1769 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
1770 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
1771 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
1772 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
1773 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
1774 };
1775 
1776 /**
1777  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
1778  *
1779  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
1780  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
1781  *
1782  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
1783  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
1784  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
1785  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
1786  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
1787  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
1788  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
1789  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
1790  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
1791  */
1792 enum mpath_info_flags {
1793 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
1794 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
1795 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
1796 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
1797 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
1798 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
1799 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
1800 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
1801 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
1802 };
1803 
1804 /**
1805  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
1806  *
1807  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
1808  *
1809  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
1810  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
1811  * @sn: target sequence number
1812  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
1813  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
1814  * @flags: mesh path flags
1815  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
1816  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
1817  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1818  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
1819  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1820  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1821  * @hop_count: hops to destination
1822  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
1823  */
1824 struct mpath_info {
1825 	u32 filled;
1826 	u32 frame_qlen;
1827 	u32 sn;
1828 	u32 metric;
1829 	u32 exptime;
1830 	u32 discovery_timeout;
1831 	u8 discovery_retries;
1832 	u8 flags;
1833 	u8 hop_count;
1834 	u32 path_change_count;
1835 
1836 	int generation;
1837 };
1838 
1839 /**
1840  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
1841  *
1842  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
1843  *
1844  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
1845  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1846  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
1847  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1848  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
1849  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1850  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1851  *	(or NULL for no change)
1852  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
1853  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
1854  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1855  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
1856  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
1857  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
1858  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
1859  */
1860 struct bss_parameters {
1861 	int use_cts_prot;
1862 	int use_short_preamble;
1863 	int use_short_slot_time;
1864 	const u8 *basic_rates;
1865 	u8 basic_rates_len;
1866 	int ap_isolate;
1867 	int ht_opmode;
1868 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
1869 };
1870 
1871 /**
1872  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
1873  *
1874  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
1875  *
1876  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
1877  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
1878  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
1879  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
1880  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
1881  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
1882  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
1883  *	mesh interface
1884  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
1885  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
1886  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
1887  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
1888  *	elements
1889  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
1890  *	detect compatible mesh peers
1891  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
1892  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
1893  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
1894  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
1895  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
1896  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
1897  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
1898  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1899  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
1900  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
1901  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1902  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
1903  *	element
1904  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1905  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
1906  *	element
1907  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
1908  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
1909  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
1910  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
1911  *	announcements are transmitted
1912  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
1913  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
1914  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
1915  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
1916  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
1917  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
1918  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
1919  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
1920  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
1921  *	station to establish a peer link
1922  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
1923  *
1924  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1925  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
1926  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
1927  *
1928  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
1929  *	PREQs are transmitted.
1930  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
1931  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
1932  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
1933  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
1934  *	setting for new peer links.
1935  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
1936  *	after transmitting its beacon.
1937  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
1938  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
1939  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
1940  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
1941  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
1942  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
1943  *      in the mesh path table
1944  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
1945  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
1946  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
1947  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
1948  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
1949  */
1950 struct mesh_config {
1951 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
1952 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
1953 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
1954 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
1955 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
1956 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
1957 	u8 element_ttl;
1958 	bool auto_open_plinks;
1959 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
1960 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
1961 	u32 path_refresh_time;
1962 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
1963 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
1964 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
1965 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
1966 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
1967 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
1968 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
1969 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
1970 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
1971 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
1972 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
1973 	s32 rssi_threshold;
1974 	u16 ht_opmode;
1975 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
1976 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
1977 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
1978 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
1979 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
1980 	u32 plink_timeout;
1981 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
1982 };
1983 
1984 /**
1985  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
1986  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1987  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
1988  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
1989  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
1990  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
1991  * @path_metric: which metric to use
1992  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
1993  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
1994  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
1995  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
1996  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
1997  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
1998  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
1999  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2000  * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2001  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2002  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2003  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2004  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2005  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2006  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2007  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2008  *
2009  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2010  */
2011 struct mesh_setup {
2012 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2013 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2014 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2015 	u8 sync_method;
2016 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2017 	u8 path_metric;
2018 	u8 auth_id;
2019 	const u8 *ie;
2020 	u8 ie_len;
2021 	bool is_authenticated;
2022 	bool is_secure;
2023 	bool user_mpm;
2024 	u8 dtim_period;
2025 	u16 beacon_interval;
2026 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2027 	u32 basic_rates;
2028 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2029 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2030 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2031 };
2032 
2033 /**
2034  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2035  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2036  *
2037  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2038  */
2039 struct ocb_setup {
2040 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2041 };
2042 
2043 /**
2044  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2045  * @ac: AC identifier
2046  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2047  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2048  *	1..32767]
2049  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2050  *	1..32767]
2051  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2052  */
2053 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2054 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2055 	u16 txop;
2056 	u16 cwmin;
2057 	u16 cwmax;
2058 	u8 aifs;
2059 };
2060 
2061 /**
2062  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2063  *
2064  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2065  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2066  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2067  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2068  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2069  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2070  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2071  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2072  * in the wiphy structure.
2073  *
2074  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2075  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2076  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2077  *
2078  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2079  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2080  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2081  * to userspace.
2082  */
2083 
2084 /**
2085  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2086  * @ssid: the SSID
2087  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2088  */
2089 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2090 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2091 	u8 ssid_len;
2092 };
2093 
2094 /**
2095  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2096  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2097  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2098  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2099  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2100  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2101  *	userspace will be notified of that
2102  */
2103 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2104 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2105 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2106 	bool aborted;
2107 };
2108 
2109 /**
2110  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2111  *
2112  * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for
2113  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2114  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2115  *	 which the above info relvant to
2116  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2117  * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used
2118  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2119  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2120  */
2121 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2122 	u32 short_ssid;
2123 	u32 channel_idx;
2124 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2125 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2126 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2127 	bool psc_no_listen;
2128 };
2129 
2130 /**
2131  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2132  *
2133  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2134  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2135  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2136  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2137  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2138  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2139  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2140  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2141  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2142  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2143  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2144  *	%duration field.
2145  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2146  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2147  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2148  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2149  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2150  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2151  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2152  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2153  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2154  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2155  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2156  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2157  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2158  *	true if this is the second scan request
2159  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2160  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2161  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2162  */
2163 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2164 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2165 	int n_ssids;
2166 	u32 n_channels;
2167 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2168 	const u8 *ie;
2169 	size_t ie_len;
2170 	u16 duration;
2171 	bool duration_mandatory;
2172 	u32 flags;
2173 
2174 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2175 
2176 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2177 
2178 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2179 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2180 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2181 
2182 	/* internal */
2183 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2184 	unsigned long scan_start;
2185 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2186 	bool notified;
2187 	bool no_cck;
2188 	bool scan_6ghz;
2189 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2190 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2191 
2192 	/* keep last */
2193 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2194 };
2195 
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2196 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2197 {
2198 	int i;
2199 
2200 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2201 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2202 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2203 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2204 	}
2205 }
2206 
2207 /**
2208  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2209  *
2210  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2211  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2212  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2213  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2214  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2215  * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2216  *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support
2217  *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2218  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2219  *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2220  *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2221  *	corresponding matchset.
2222  */
2223 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2224 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2225 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2226 	s32 rssi_thold;
2227 	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2228 };
2229 
2230 /**
2231  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2232  *
2233  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2234  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2235  *	infinite loop.
2236  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2237  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2238  */
2239 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2240 	u32 interval;
2241 	u32 iterations;
2242 };
2243 
2244 /**
2245  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2246  *
2247  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2248  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2249  */
2250 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2251 	enum nl80211_band band;
2252 	s8 delta;
2253 };
2254 
2255 /**
2256  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2257  *
2258  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2259  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2260  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2261  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2262  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2263  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2264  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2265  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2266  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2267  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2268  *	(others are filtered out).
2269  *	If ommited, all results are passed.
2270  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2271  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2272  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2273  * @dev: the interface
2274  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2275  * @channels: channels to scan
2276  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2277  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2278  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2279  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2280  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2281  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2282  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2283  *	index must be executed first.
2284  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2285  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2286  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2287  *	owned by a particular socket)
2288  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2289  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2290  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2291  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2292  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2293  *	supported.
2294  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2295  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2296  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2297  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2298  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2299  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2300  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2301  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2302  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2303  *	comparisions.
2304  */
2305 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2306 	u64 reqid;
2307 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2308 	int n_ssids;
2309 	u32 n_channels;
2310 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2311 	const u8 *ie;
2312 	size_t ie_len;
2313 	u32 flags;
2314 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2315 	int n_match_sets;
2316 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2317 	u32 delay;
2318 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2319 	int n_scan_plans;
2320 
2321 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2322 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2323 
2324 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2325 	s8 relative_rssi;
2326 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2327 
2328 	/* internal */
2329 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2330 	struct net_device *dev;
2331 	unsigned long scan_start;
2332 	bool report_results;
2333 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2334 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2335 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2336 	struct list_head list;
2337 
2338 	/* keep last */
2339 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2340 };
2341 
2342 /**
2343  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2344  *
2345  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2346  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2347  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2348  */
2349 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2350 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2351 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2352 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2353 };
2354 
2355 /**
2356  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2357  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2358  * @scan_width: scan width that was used
2359  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2360  *	signal type
2361  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2362  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2363  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2364  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2365  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2366  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2367  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2368  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2369  *	by %parent_bssid.
2370  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2371  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2372  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2373  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2374  */
2375 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2376 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2377 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2378 	s32 signal;
2379 	u64 boottime_ns;
2380 	u64 parent_tsf;
2381 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2382 	u8 chains;
2383 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2384 };
2385 
2386 /**
2387  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2388  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2389  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2390  * @len: length of the IEs
2391  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2392  * @data: IE data
2393  */
2394 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2395 	u64 tsf;
2396 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2397 	int len;
2398 	bool from_beacon;
2399 	u8 data[];
2400 };
2401 
2402 /**
2403  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2404  *
2405  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2406  * for use in scan results and similar.
2407  *
2408  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2409  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
2410  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2411  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2412  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2413  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2414  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2415  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2416  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2417  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2418  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2419  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2420  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2421  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2422  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2423  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2424  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2425  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2426  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2427  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2428  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2429  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2430  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2431  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2432  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2433  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2434  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2435  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2436  */
2437 struct cfg80211_bss {
2438 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2439 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2440 
2441 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2442 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2443 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2444 
2445 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2446 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2447 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2448 
2449 	s32 signal;
2450 
2451 	u16 beacon_interval;
2452 	u16 capability;
2453 
2454 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2455 	u8 chains;
2456 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2457 
2458 	u8 bssid_index;
2459 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2460 
2461 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2462 };
2463 
2464 /**
2465  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2466  * @bss: the bss to search
2467  * @id: the element ID
2468  *
2469  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2470  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2471  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2472  */
2473 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2474 
2475 /**
2476  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2477  * @bss: the bss to search
2478  * @id: the element ID
2479  *
2480  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2481  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2482  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2483  */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)2484 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2485 {
2486 	return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2487 }
2488 
2489 
2490 /**
2491  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2492  *
2493  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2494  * authentication.
2495  *
2496  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2497  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
2498  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2499  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2500  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2501  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2502  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2503  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2504  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2505  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2506  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2507  *	transaction sequence number field.
2508  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2509  */
2510 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2511 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2512 	const u8 *ie;
2513 	size_t ie_len;
2514 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2515 	const u8 *key;
2516 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2517 	const u8 *auth_data;
2518 	size_t auth_data_len;
2519 };
2520 
2521 /**
2522  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2523  *
2524  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
2525  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
2526  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
2527  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
2528  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
2529  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
2530  *	request (connect callback).
2531  */
2532 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
2533 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
2534 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
2535 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
2536 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
2537 };
2538 
2539 /**
2540  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
2541  *
2542  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2543  * (re)association.
2544  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
2545  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
2546  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
2547  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
2548  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
2549  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2550  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
2551  * @crypto: crypto settings
2552  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2553  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2554  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2555  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2556  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2557  *	frame.
2558  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2559  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2560  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2561  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2562  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
2563  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
2564  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
2565  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
2566  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
2567  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
2568  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
2569  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2570  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
2571  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
2572  */
2573 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
2574 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2575 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
2576 	size_t ie_len;
2577 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2578 	bool use_mfp;
2579 	u32 flags;
2580 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2581 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2582 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
2583 	const u8 *fils_kek;
2584 	size_t fils_kek_len;
2585 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
2586 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
2587 };
2588 
2589 /**
2590  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
2591  *
2592  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2593  * deauthentication.
2594  *
2595  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from
2596  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
2597  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2598  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
2599  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
2600  *	do not set a deauth frame
2601  */
2602 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
2603 	const u8 *bssid;
2604 	const u8 *ie;
2605 	size_t ie_len;
2606 	u16 reason_code;
2607 	bool local_state_change;
2608 };
2609 
2610 /**
2611  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
2612  *
2613  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2614  * disassociation.
2615  *
2616  * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from
2617  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
2618  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2619  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
2620  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
2621  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
2622  */
2623 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
2624 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2625 	const u8 *ie;
2626 	size_t ie_len;
2627 	u16 reason_code;
2628 	bool local_state_change;
2629 };
2630 
2631 /**
2632  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
2633  *
2634  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
2635  * method.
2636  *
2637  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
2638  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
2639  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
2640  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
2641  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
2642  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
2643  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
2644  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
2645  * @ie_len: length of that
2646  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2647  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
2648  *	after joining
2649  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
2650  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
2651  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
2652  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
2653  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2654  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2655  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2656  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2657  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2658  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
2659  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
2660  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2661  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2662  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2663  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
2664  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
2665  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
2666  */
2667 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
2668 	const u8 *ssid;
2669 	const u8 *bssid;
2670 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2671 	const u8 *ie;
2672 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
2673 	u16 beacon_interval;
2674 	u32 basic_rates;
2675 	bool channel_fixed;
2676 	bool privacy;
2677 	bool control_port;
2678 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2679 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2680 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2681 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2682 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2683 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
2684 	int wep_tx_key;
2685 };
2686 
2687 /**
2688  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
2689  *
2690  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
2691  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
2692  * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
2693  * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
2694  */
2695 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
2696 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
2697 	union {
2698 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
2699 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
2700 	} param;
2701 };
2702 
2703 /**
2704  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
2705  *
2706  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2707  * authentication and association.
2708  *
2709  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
2710  *	on scan results)
2711  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
2712  *	%NULL if not specified
2713  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
2714  *	results)
2715  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
2716  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
2717  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
2718  *	to use.
2719  * @ssid: SSID
2720  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
2721  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2722  * @ie: IEs for association request
2723  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
2724  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
2725  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
2726  * @crypto: crypto settings
2727  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2728  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2729  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2730  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2731  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
2732  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
2733  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2734  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2735  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2736  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
2737  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
2738  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
2739  *	networks.
2740  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
2741  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2742  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2743  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2744  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2745  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2746  *	frame.
2747  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
2748  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
2749  *	data IE.
2750  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
2751  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
2752  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
2753  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2754  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
2755  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
2756  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2757  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
2758  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
2759  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
2760  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
2761  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
2762  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
2763  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
2764  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
2765  */
2766 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
2767 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2768 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
2769 	const u8 *bssid;
2770 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
2771 	const u8 *ssid;
2772 	size_t ssid_len;
2773 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2774 	const u8 *ie;
2775 	size_t ie_len;
2776 	bool privacy;
2777 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
2778 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2779 	const u8 *key;
2780 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2781 	u32 flags;
2782 	int bg_scan_period;
2783 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2784 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2785 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
2786 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
2787 	bool pbss;
2788 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
2789 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
2790 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
2791 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
2792 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
2793 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
2794 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
2795 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
2796 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
2797 	bool want_1x;
2798 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
2799 };
2800 
2801 /**
2802  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
2803  *
2804  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
2805  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
2806  *
2807  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
2808  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
2809  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
2810  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
2811  */
2812 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
2813 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
2814 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
2815 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
2816 };
2817 
2818 /**
2819  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
2820  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
2821  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
2822  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
2823  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
2824  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
2825  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
2826  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
2827  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
2828  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
2829  */
2830 enum wiphy_params_flags {
2831 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
2832 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
2833 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
2834 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
2835 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
2836 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
2837 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
2838 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
2839 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
2840 };
2841 
2842 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
2843 
2844 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
2845 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
2846 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
2847 
2848 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
2849 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
2850 
2851 /**
2852  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
2853  *
2854  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
2855  * caching.
2856  *
2857  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
2858  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
2859  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
2860  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
2861  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
2862  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
2863  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
2864  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
2865  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
2866  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
2867  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
2868  *	%NULL).
2869  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
2870  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
2871  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
2872  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
2873  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
2874  *	used for it expires.
2875  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
2876  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
2877  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
2878  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
2879  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
2880  */
2881 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
2882 	const u8 *bssid;
2883 	const u8 *pmkid;
2884 	const u8 *pmk;
2885 	size_t pmk_len;
2886 	const u8 *ssid;
2887 	size_t ssid_len;
2888 	const u8 *cache_id;
2889 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
2890 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
2891 };
2892 
2893 /**
2894  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
2895  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
2896  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
2897  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
2898  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
2899  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
2900  *
2901  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
2902  * memory, free @mask only!
2903  */
2904 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
2905 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
2906 	int pattern_len;
2907 	int pkt_offset;
2908 };
2909 
2910 /**
2911  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
2912  *
2913  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
2914  * @src: source IP address
2915  * @dst: destination IP address
2916  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
2917  * @src_port: source port
2918  * @dst_port: destination port
2919  * @payload_len: data payload length
2920  * @payload: data payload buffer
2921  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
2922  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
2923  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
2924  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
2925  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
2926  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
2927  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
2928  */
2929 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
2930 	struct socket *sock;
2931 	__be32 src, dst;
2932 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
2933 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
2934 	int payload_len;
2935 	const u8 *payload;
2936 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
2937 	u32 data_interval;
2938 	u32 wake_len;
2939 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
2940 	u32 tokens_size;
2941 	/* must be last, variable member */
2942 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
2943 };
2944 
2945 /**
2946  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
2947  *
2948  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
2949  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
2950  *	operating as normal during suspend
2951  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
2952  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
2953  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
2954  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
2955  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
2956  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
2957  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
2958  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
2959  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
2960  *	NULL if not configured.
2961  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
2962  */
2963 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
2964 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
2965 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
2966 	     rfkill_release;
2967 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
2968 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
2969 	int n_patterns;
2970 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
2971 };
2972 
2973 /**
2974  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
2975  *
2976  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
2977  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
2978  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
2979  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
2980  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
2981  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
2982  */
2983 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
2984 	int delay;
2985 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
2986 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
2987 	int n_patterns;
2988 };
2989 
2990 /**
2991  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
2992  *
2993  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
2994  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
2995  * @n_rules: number of rules
2996  */
2997 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
2998 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
2999 	int n_rules;
3000 };
3001 
3002 /**
3003  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3004  *
3005  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3006  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3007  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3008  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3009  *	occurred (in MHz)
3010  */
3011 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3012 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3013 	int n_channels;
3014 	u32 channels[];
3015 };
3016 
3017 /**
3018  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3019  *
3020  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3021  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3022  *	match information.
3023  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3024  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3025  */
3026 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3027 	int n_matches;
3028 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3029 };
3030 
3031 /**
3032  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3033  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3034  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3035  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3036  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3037  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3038  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3039  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3040  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3041  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3042  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3043  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3044  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3045  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3046  *	it is.
3047  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3048  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3049  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3050  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3051  */
3052 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3053 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3054 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3055 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3056 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3057 	s32 pattern_idx;
3058 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3059 	const void *packet;
3060 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3061 };
3062 
3063 /**
3064  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3065  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3066  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3067  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3068  * @kek_len: length of kek
3069  * @kck_len length of kck
3070  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3071  */
3072 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3073 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3074 	u32 akm;
3075 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3076 };
3077 
3078 /**
3079  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3080  *
3081  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3082  *
3083  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3084  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3085  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3086  */
3087 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3088 	u16 md;
3089 	const u8 *ie;
3090 	size_t ie_len;
3091 };
3092 
3093 /**
3094  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3095  *
3096  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3097  *
3098  * @chan: channel to use
3099  * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required
3100  * @wait: duration for ROC
3101  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3102  * @len: buffer length
3103  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3104  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3105  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3106  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3107  */
3108 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3109 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3110 	bool offchan;
3111 	unsigned int wait;
3112 	const u8 *buf;
3113 	size_t len;
3114 	bool no_cck;
3115 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3116 	int n_csa_offsets;
3117 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3118 };
3119 
3120 /**
3121  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3122  *
3123  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3124  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3125  */
3126 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3127 	u8 dscp;
3128 	u8 up;
3129 };
3130 
3131 /**
3132  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3133  *
3134  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3135  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3136  */
3137 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3138 	u8 low;
3139 	u8 high;
3140 };
3141 
3142 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3143 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3144 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3145 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3146 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3147 
3148 /**
3149  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3150  *
3151  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3152  *
3153  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3154  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3155  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3156  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3157  */
3158 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3159 	u8 num_des;
3160 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3161 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3162 };
3163 
3164 /**
3165  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3166  *
3167  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3168  *
3169  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3170  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3171  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3172  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3173  */
3174 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3175 	u8 master_pref;
3176 	u8 bands;
3177 };
3178 
3179 /**
3180  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3181  * configuration
3182  *
3183  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3184  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3185  */
3186 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3187 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3188 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3189 };
3190 
3191 /**
3192  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3193  *
3194  * @filter: the content of the filter
3195  * @len: the length of the filter
3196  */
3197 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3198 	const u8 *filter;
3199 	u8 len;
3200 };
3201 
3202 /**
3203  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3204  *
3205  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3206  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3207  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3208  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3209  *	implementation specific.
3210  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3211  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3212  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3213  * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up
3214  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3215  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3216  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3217  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3218  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3219  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3220  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3221  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3222  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3223  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3224  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3225  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3226  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3227  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3228  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3229  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3230  */
3231 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3232 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3233 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3234 	u8 publish_type;
3235 	bool close_range;
3236 	bool publish_bcast;
3237 	bool subscribe_active;
3238 	u8 followup_id;
3239 	u8 followup_reqid;
3240 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3241 	u32 ttl;
3242 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3243 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3244 	bool srf_include;
3245 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3246 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3247 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3248 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3249 	int srf_num_macs;
3250 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3251 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3252 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3253 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3254 	u8 instance_id;
3255 	u64 cookie;
3256 };
3257 
3258 /**
3259  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3260  *
3261  * @aa: authenticator address
3262  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3263  * @pmk: the PMK material
3264  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3265  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3266  *	holds PMK-R0.
3267  */
3268 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3269 	const u8 *aa;
3270 	u8 pmk_len;
3271 	const u8 *pmk;
3272 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3273 };
3274 
3275 /**
3276  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3277  *
3278  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3279  *
3280  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3281  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3282  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3283  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3284  *	authentication response command interface.
3285  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3286  *	authentication response command interface.
3287  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3288  *	authentication request event interface.
3289  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3290  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3291  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3292  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3293  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3294  */
3295 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3296 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3297 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3298 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3299 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3300 	u16 status;
3301 	const u8 *pmkid;
3302 };
3303 
3304 /**
3305  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3306  *
3307  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3308  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3309  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3310  *	answered
3311  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3312  *	successfully answered
3313  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3314  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3315  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3316  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3317  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3318  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3319  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3320  *	the responder
3321  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3322  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3323  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3324  */
3325 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3326 	u32 filled;
3327 	u32 success_num;
3328 	u32 partial_num;
3329 	u32 failed_num;
3330 	u32 asap_num;
3331 	u32 non_asap_num;
3332 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3333 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3334 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3335 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3336 };
3337 
3338 /**
3339  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3340  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3341  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3342  *	reason than just "failure"
3343  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3344  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3345  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3346  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3347  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3348  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3349  *	by the responder
3350  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3351  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3352  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3353  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3354  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3355  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3356  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3357  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3358  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3359  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3360  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3361  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3362  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3363  *	the square root of the variance)
3364  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3365  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3366  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3367  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3368  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3369  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3370  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3371  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3372  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3373  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3374  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3375  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3376  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3377  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3378  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3379  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3380  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3381  */
3382 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3383 	const u8 *lci;
3384 	const u8 *civicloc;
3385 	unsigned int lci_len;
3386 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3387 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3388 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3389 	s16 burst_index;
3390 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3391 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3392 	u8 burst_duration;
3393 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3394 	s32 rssi_avg;
3395 	s32 rssi_spread;
3396 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3397 	s64 rtt_avg;
3398 	s64 rtt_variance;
3399 	s64 rtt_spread;
3400 	s64 dist_avg;
3401 	s64 dist_variance;
3402 	s64 dist_spread;
3403 
3404 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3405 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3406 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3407 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3408 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3409 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3410 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3411 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3412 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3413 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3414 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3415 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3416 };
3417 
3418 /**
3419  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3420  * @addr: address of the peer
3421  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3422  *	measurement was made)
3423  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3424  * @status: status of the measurement
3425  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3426  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3427  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3428  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3429  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3430  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
3431  */
3432 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3433 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3434 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3435 
3436 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3437 
3438 	u8 final:1,
3439 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
3440 
3441 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3442 
3443 	union {
3444 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3445 	};
3446 };
3447 
3448 /**
3449  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3450  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3451  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3452  * @burst_period: burst period to use
3453  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3454  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3455  * @burst_duration: burst duration
3456  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3457  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3458  * @request_lci: request LCI information
3459  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3460  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
3461  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3462  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3463  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
3464  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3465  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3466  *
3467  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3468  */
3469 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3470 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3471 	u16 burst_period;
3472 	u8 requested:1,
3473 	   asap:1,
3474 	   request_lci:1,
3475 	   request_civicloc:1,
3476 	   trigger_based:1,
3477 	   non_trigger_based:1;
3478 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3479 	u8 burst_duration;
3480 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3481 	u8 ftmr_retries;
3482 };
3483 
3484 /**
3485  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
3486  * @addr: MAC address
3487  * @chandef: channel to use
3488  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
3489  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
3490  */
3491 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
3492 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3493 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3494 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
3495 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
3496 };
3497 
3498 /**
3499  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
3500  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
3501  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
3502  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
3503  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
3504  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
3505  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
3506  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
3507  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
3508  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
3509  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
3510  *	zero it means there's no timeout
3511  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
3512  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
3513  */
3514 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
3515 	u64 cookie;
3516 	void *drv_data;
3517 	u32 n_peers;
3518 	u32 nl_portid;
3519 
3520 	u32 timeout;
3521 
3522 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3523 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3524 
3525 	struct list_head list;
3526 
3527 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[];
3528 };
3529 
3530 /**
3531  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
3532  *
3533  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
3534  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
3535  *
3536  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
3537  *
3538  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
3539  *	has to be done.
3540  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
3541  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
3542  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
3543  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
3544  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
3545  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
3546  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
3547  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
3548  */
3549 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
3550 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3551 	u16 status;
3552 	const u8 *ie;
3553 	size_t ie_len;
3554 };
3555 
3556 /**
3557  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
3558  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3559  *	for the entire device
3560  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3561  *	for the given interface
3562  * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
3563  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
3564  *	for these subtypes
3565  */
3566 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
3567 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
3568 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
3569 };
3570 
3571 /**
3572  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
3573  *
3574  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
3575  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
3576  *
3577  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
3578  * on success or a negative error code.
3579  *
3580  * All operations are currently invoked under rtnl for consistency with the
3581  * wireless extensions but this is subject to reevaluation as soon as this
3582  * code is used more widely and we have a first user without wext.
3583  *
3584  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
3585  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
3586  *	configured for the device.
3587  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
3588  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
3589  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
3590  *	the device.
3591  *
3592  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
3593  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
3594  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
3595  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
3596  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
3597  *
3598  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
3599  *
3600  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
3601  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
3602  *
3603  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
3604  *	when adding a group key.
3605  *
3606  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
3607  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
3608  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
3609  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
3610  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
3611  *
3612  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
3613  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist.
3614  *
3615  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface
3616  *
3617  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface
3618  *
3619  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface
3620  *
3621  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
3622  *
3623  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
3624  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
3625  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
3626  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
3627  *
3628  * @add_station: Add a new station.
3629  * @del_station: Remove a station
3630  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
3631  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
3632  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
3633  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
3634  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
3635  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
3636  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3637  *
3638  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
3639  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
3640  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
3641  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
3642  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3643  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
3644  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3645  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
3646  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3647  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
3648  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3649  *
3650  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
3651  *
3652  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
3653  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
3654  *	set, and which to leave alone.
3655  *
3656  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
3657  *
3658  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
3659  *
3660  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
3661  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
3662  *	join the mesh instead.
3663  *
3664  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
3665  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
3666  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
3667  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
3668  *
3669  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
3670  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
3671  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
3672  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
3673  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
3674  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
3675  *
3676  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
3677  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3678  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
3679  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3680  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
3681  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3682  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
3683  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3684  *
3685  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
3686  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
3687  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
3688  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
3689  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
3690  *	was received.
3691  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
3692  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
3693  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
3694  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
3695  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
3696  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
3697  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
3698  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
3699  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
3700  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
3701  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
3702  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3703  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
3704  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
3705  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
3706  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
3707  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
3708  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
3709  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
3710  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3711  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
3712  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
3713  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
3714  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
3715  *
3716  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
3717  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
3718  *	to a merge.
3719  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3720  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
3721  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3722  *
3723  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
3724  *	MESH mode)
3725  *
3726  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
3727  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
3728  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
3729  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
3730  *
3731  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
3732  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
3733  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
3734  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
3735  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
3736  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
3737  *	return 0 if successful
3738  *
3739  * @set_wds_peer: set the WDS peer for a WDS interface
3740  *
3741  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
3742  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
3743  *
3744  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
3745  *
3746  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
3747  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
3748  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
3749  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
3750  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
3751  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
3752  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
3753  *	the duration value.
3754  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
3755  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
3756  *	frame on another channel
3757  *
3758  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
3759  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
3760  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
3761  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
3762  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
3763  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
3764  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
3765  *
3766  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
3767  *
3768  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
3769  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
3770  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
3771  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
3772  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
3773  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
3774  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
3775  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
3776  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
3777  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
3778  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
3779  *	disabled.)
3780  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
3781  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
3782  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
3783  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
3784  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
3785  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
3786  *	thresholds.
3787  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
3788  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
3789  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
3790  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
3791  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
3792  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
3793  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
3794  *
3795  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
3796  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
3797  *
3798  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3799  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3800  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3801  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3802  *
3803  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3804  *
3805  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
3806  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
3807  *
3808  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
3809  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
3810  *
3811  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
3812  *
3813  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
3814  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
3815  *	current monitoring channel.
3816  *
3817  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
3818  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
3819  *
3820  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
3821  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
3822  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
3823  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
3824  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
3825  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
3826  *
3827  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
3828  *
3829  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
3830  *	was finished on another phy.
3831  *
3832  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
3833  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
3834  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
3835  *
3836  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
3837  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
3838  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
3839  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
3840  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
3841  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
3842  *
3843  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
3844  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
3845  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
3846  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
3847  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
3848  *	as soon as possible.
3849  *
3850  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
3851  *
3852  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
3853  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
3854  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
3855  *
3856  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
3857  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
3858  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
3859  *	account.
3860  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
3861  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
3862  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
3863  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
3864  *	rejected)
3865  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
3866  *
3867  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
3868  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3869  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
3870  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3871  *
3872  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3873  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3874  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
3875  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3876  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3877  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
3878  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
3879  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
3880  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
3881  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
3882  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
3883  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
3884  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
3885  *	provided @nan_func.
3886  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
3887  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
3888  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
3889  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
3890  *
3891  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
3892  *
3893  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
3894  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
3895  *
3896  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
3897  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
3898  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
3899  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3900  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
3901  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3902  *
3903  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
3904  *     user space
3905  *
3906  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
3907  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
3908  *
3909  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3910  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3911  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
3912  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
3913  *
3914  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
3915  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
3916  *	DH IE through this interface.
3917  *
3918  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
3919  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
3920  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
3921  *	This callback may sleep.
3922  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
3923  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
3924  */
3925 struct cfg80211_ops {
3926 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
3927 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3928 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
3929 
3930 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3931 						  const char *name,
3932 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
3933 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
3934 						  struct vif_params *params);
3935 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3936 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3937 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3938 				       struct net_device *dev,
3939 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
3940 				       struct vif_params *params);
3941 
3942 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3943 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
3944 			   struct key_params *params);
3945 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3946 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
3947 			   void *cookie,
3948 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
3949 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3950 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr);
3951 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3952 				   struct net_device *netdev,
3953 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
3954 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3955 					struct net_device *netdev,
3956 					u8 key_index);
3957 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3958 					  struct net_device *netdev,
3959 					  u8 key_index);
3960 
3961 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3962 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
3963 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3964 				 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info);
3965 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
3966 
3967 
3968 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3969 			       const u8 *mac,
3970 			       struct station_parameters *params);
3971 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3972 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
3973 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3974 				  const u8 *mac,
3975 				  struct station_parameters *params);
3976 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3977 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
3978 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3979 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
3980 
3981 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3982 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
3983 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3984 			       const u8 *dst);
3985 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3986 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
3987 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3988 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3989 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3990 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
3991 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3992 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3993 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3994 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3995 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
3996 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3997 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3998 				struct net_device *dev,
3999 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4000 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4001 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4002 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4003 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4004 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4005 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4006 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4007 
4008 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4009 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4010 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4011 
4012 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4013 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4014 
4015 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4016 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4017 
4018 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4019 					     struct net_device *dev,
4020 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4021 
4022 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4023 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4024 
4025 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4026 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4027 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4028 
4029 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4030 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4031 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4032 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4033 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4034 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4035 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4036 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4037 
4038 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4039 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4040 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4041 					 struct net_device *dev,
4042 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4043 					 u32 changed);
4044 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4045 			      u16 reason_code);
4046 
4047 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4048 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4049 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4050 
4051 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4052 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4053 
4054 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4055 
4056 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4057 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4058 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4059 				int *dbm);
4060 
4061 	int	(*set_wds_peer)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4062 				const u8 *addr);
4063 
4064 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4065 
4066 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4067 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4068 				void *data, int len);
4069 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4070 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4071 				 void *data, int len);
4072 #endif
4073 
4074 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4075 				    struct net_device *dev,
4076 				    const u8 *peer,
4077 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4078 
4079 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4080 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4081 
4082 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4083 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4084 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4085 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4086 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4087 
4088 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4089 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4090 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4091 				     unsigned int duration,
4092 				     u64 *cookie);
4093 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4094 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4095 					    u64 cookie);
4096 
4097 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4098 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4099 			   u64 *cookie);
4100 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4101 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4102 				       u64 cookie);
4103 
4104 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4105 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4106 
4107 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4108 				       struct net_device *dev,
4109 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4110 
4111 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4112 					     struct net_device *dev,
4113 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4114 
4115 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4116 				      struct net_device *dev,
4117 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4118 
4119 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4120 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4121 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4122 
4123 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4124 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4125 
4126 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4127 				struct net_device *dev,
4128 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4129 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4130 				   u64 reqid);
4131 
4132 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4133 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4134 
4135 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4136 			     const u8 *peer, u8 action_code,  u8 dialog_token,
4137 			     u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability,
4138 			     bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4139 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4140 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4141 
4142 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4143 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4144 
4145 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4146 				  struct net_device *dev,
4147 				  u16 noack_map);
4148 
4149 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4150 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4151 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4152 
4153 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4154 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4155 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4156 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4157 
4158 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4159 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4160 
4161 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4162 					 struct net_device *dev,
4163 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4164 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4165 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4166 				struct net_device *dev);
4167 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4168 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4169 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4170 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4171 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4172 				    u16 duration);
4173 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4174 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4175 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4176 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4177 
4178 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4179 				  struct net_device *dev,
4180 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4181 
4182 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4183 			       struct net_device *dev,
4184 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4185 
4186 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4187 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4188 
4189 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4190 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4191 			     u16 admitted_time);
4192 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4193 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4194 
4195 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4196 				       struct net_device *dev,
4197 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4198 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4199 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4200 					      struct net_device *dev,
4201 					      const u8 *addr);
4202 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4203 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4204 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4205 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4206 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4207 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4208 			       u64 cookie);
4209 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4210 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4211 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4212 				   u32 changes);
4213 
4214 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4215 					    struct net_device *dev,
4216 					    const bool enabled);
4217 
4218 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4219 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4220 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4221 
4222 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4223 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4224 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4225 			   const u8 *aa);
4226 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4227 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4228 
4229 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4230 				   struct net_device *dev,
4231 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4232 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4233 				   const bool noencrypt,
4234 				   u64 *cookie);
4235 
4236 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4237 				struct net_device *dev,
4238 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4239 
4240 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4241 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4242 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4243 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4244 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4245 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4246 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4247 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4248 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4249 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4250 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4251 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4252 };
4253 
4254 /*
4255  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4256  * and registration/helper functions
4257  */
4258 
4259 /**
4260  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4261  *
4262  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4263  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4264  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4265  *	wiphy at all
4266  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4267  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4268  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4269  *	reason to override the default
4270  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4271  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4272  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4273  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4274  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4275  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4276  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4277  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4278  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4279  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4280  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4281  *	firmware.
4282  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4283  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4284  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4285  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4286  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4287  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4288  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4289  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4290  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4291  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4292  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4293  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4294  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4295  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4296  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4297  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4298  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4299  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4300  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation
4301  *	before connection.
4302  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4303  */
4304 enum wiphy_flags {
4305 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4306 	/* use hole at 1 */
4307 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
4308 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4309 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4310 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4311 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4312 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4313 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4314 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4315 	/* use hole at 11 */
4316 	/* use hole at 12 */
4317 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4318 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4319 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4320 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4321 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4322 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4323 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4324 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4325 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4326 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4327 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
4328 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP		= BIT(24),
4329 };
4330 
4331 /**
4332  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4333  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4334  * @types: interface types (bits)
4335  */
4336 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4337 	u16 max;
4338 	u16 types;
4339 };
4340 
4341 /**
4342  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4343  *
4344  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4345  * combinations it supports concurrently.
4346  *
4347  * Examples:
4348  *
4349  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4350  *
4351  *    .. code-block:: c
4352  *
4353  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4354  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4355  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, },
4356  *	};
4357  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4358  *		.limits = limits1,
4359  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4360  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
4361  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4362  *	};
4363  *
4364  *
4365  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4366  *
4367  *    .. code-block:: c
4368  *
4369  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4370  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4371  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4372  *	};
4373  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4374  *		.limits = limits2,
4375  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4376  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
4377  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
4378  *	};
4379  *
4380  *
4381  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4382  *
4383  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4384  *
4385  *    .. code-block:: c
4386  *
4387  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
4388  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4389  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
4390  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
4391  *	};
4392  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
4393  *		.limits = limits3,
4394  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
4395  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
4396  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
4397  *	};
4398  *
4399  */
4400 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
4401 	/**
4402 	 * @limits:
4403 	 * limits for the given interface types
4404 	 */
4405 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
4406 
4407 	/**
4408 	 * @num_different_channels:
4409 	 * can use up to this many different channels
4410 	 */
4411 	u32 num_different_channels;
4412 
4413 	/**
4414 	 * @max_interfaces:
4415 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
4416 	 */
4417 	u16 max_interfaces;
4418 
4419 	/**
4420 	 * @n_limits:
4421 	 * number of limitations
4422 	 */
4423 	u8 n_limits;
4424 
4425 	/**
4426 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
4427 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
4428 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
4429 	 */
4430 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
4431 
4432 	/**
4433 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
4434 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
4435 	 */
4436 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
4437 
4438 	/**
4439 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
4440 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
4441 	 */
4442 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
4443 
4444 	/**
4445 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
4446 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
4447 	 *
4448 	 * = 0
4449 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
4450 	 * > 0
4451 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
4452 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
4453 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
4454 	 */
4455 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
4456 };
4457 
4458 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
4459 	u16 tx, rx;
4460 };
4461 
4462 /**
4463  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
4464  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
4465  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
4466  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
4467  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
4468  *	packet should be preserved in that case
4469  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
4470  *	(see nl80211.h)
4471  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
4472  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
4473  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
4474  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
4475  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
4476  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
4477  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
4478  */
4479 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
4480 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
4481 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
4482 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
4483 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
4484 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
4485 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
4486 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
4487 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
4488 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
4489 };
4490 
4491 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
4492 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
4493 	u32 data_payload_max;
4494 	u32 data_interval_max;
4495 	u32 wake_payload_max;
4496 	bool seq;
4497 };
4498 
4499 /**
4500  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
4501  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
4502  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
4503  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4504  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4505  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4506  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4507  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
4508  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
4509  *	scheduled scans.
4510  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
4511  *	details.
4512  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
4513  */
4514 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
4515 	u32 flags;
4516 	int n_patterns;
4517 	int pattern_max_len;
4518 	int pattern_min_len;
4519 	int max_pkt_offset;
4520 	int max_nd_match_sets;
4521 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
4522 };
4523 
4524 /**
4525  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
4526  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
4527  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
4528  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
4529  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4530  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4531  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4532  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4533  */
4534 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
4535 	int n_rules;
4536 	int max_delay;
4537 	int n_patterns;
4538 	int pattern_max_len;
4539 	int pattern_min_len;
4540 	int max_pkt_offset;
4541 };
4542 
4543 /**
4544  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
4545  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
4546  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
4547  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
4548  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
4549  */
4550 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
4551 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
4552 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
4553 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
4554 };
4555 
4556 /**
4557  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
4558  *
4559  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
4560  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
4561  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
4562  *
4563  */
4564 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
4565 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
4566 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
4567 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
4568 };
4569 
4570 /**
4571  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
4572  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
4573  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
4574  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
4575  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
4576  */
4577 
4578 struct sta_opmode_info {
4579 	u32 changed;
4580 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
4581 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
4582 	u8 rx_nss;
4583 };
4584 
4585 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
4586 
4587 /**
4588  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
4589  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
4590  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
4591  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
4592  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
4593  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
4594  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
4595  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
4596  *	dumpit calls.
4597  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
4598  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
4599  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
4600  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
4601  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
4602  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
4603  * are used with dump requests.
4604  */
4605 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
4606 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
4607 	u32 flags;
4608 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4609 		    const void *data, int data_len);
4610 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4611 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
4612 		      unsigned long *storage);
4613 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
4614 	unsigned int maxattr;
4615 };
4616 
4617 /**
4618  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
4619  * @iftype: interface type
4620  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4621  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
4622  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
4623  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
4624  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
4625  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4626  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4627  */
4628 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
4629 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
4630 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
4631 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
4632 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4633 };
4634 
4635 /**
4636  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
4637  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
4638  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
4639  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
4640  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
4641  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
4642  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
4643  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
4644  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
4645  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
4646  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
4647  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
4648  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
4649  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
4650  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
4651  *	not limited)
4652  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4653  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4654  */
4655 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
4656 	unsigned int max_peers;
4657 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
4658 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
4659 
4660 	struct {
4661 		u32 preambles;
4662 		u32 bandwidths;
4663 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
4664 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
4665 		u8 supported:1,
4666 		   asap:1,
4667 		   non_asap:1,
4668 		   request_lci:1,
4669 		   request_civicloc:1,
4670 		   trigger_based:1,
4671 		   non_trigger_based:1;
4672 	} ftm;
4673 };
4674 
4675 /**
4676  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
4677  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
4678  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
4679  *
4680  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
4681  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
4682  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4683  */
4684 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
4685 	u16 iftypes_mask;
4686 	const u32 *akm_suites;
4687 	int n_akm_suites;
4688 };
4689 
4690 /**
4691  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
4692  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
4693  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
4694  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
4695  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
4696  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
4697  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
4698  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
4699  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
4700  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
4701  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
4702  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
4703  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
4704  *	iftype_akm_suites.
4705  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4706  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
4707  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
4708  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
4709  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
4710  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
4711  *	suites are specified separately.
4712  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
4713  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
4714  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
4715  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
4716  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
4717  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
4718  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
4719  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
4720  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
4721  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
4722  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
4723  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
4724  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
4725  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
4726  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
4727  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
4728  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
4729  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
4730  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
4731  *	unregister hardware
4732  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
4733  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
4734  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
4735  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
4736  *	(see below).
4737  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
4738  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
4739  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
4740  *	must be set by driver
4741  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
4742  *	list single interface types.
4743  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
4744  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
4745  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
4746  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
4747  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
4748  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
4749  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
4750  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
4751  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
4752  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
4753  *	this variable determines its size
4754  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
4755  *	any given scan
4756  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
4757  *	the device can run concurrently.
4758  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
4759  *	for in any given scheduled scan
4760  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
4761  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
4762  *	supported.
4763  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
4764  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
4765  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
4766  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
4767  *	scans
4768  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
4769  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
4770  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
4771  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
4772  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
4773  *	scan plan supported by the device.
4774  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
4775  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
4776  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
4777  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
4778  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
4779  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
4780  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
4781  *
4782  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
4783  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
4784  *	type
4785  *
4786  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4787  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4788  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
4789  *
4790  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4791  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4792  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
4793  *
4794  * @probe_resp_offload:
4795  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
4796  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
4797  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
4798  *
4799  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
4800  *	may request, if implemented.
4801  *
4802  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
4803  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
4804  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
4805  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
4806  *
4807  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
4808  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
4809  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4810  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
4811  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4812  *
4813  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
4814  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
4815  *
4816  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
4817  *	supports for ACL.
4818  *
4819  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4820  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
4821  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
4822  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
4823  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
4824  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
4825  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
4826  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4827  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4828  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
4829  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
4830  *	capabilities are specified separately.
4831  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
4832  *
4833  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
4834  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
4835  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
4836  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
4837  *
4838  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
4839  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
4840  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
4841  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
4842  *
4843  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
4844  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
4845  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
4846  *	infinite.
4847  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
4848  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
4849  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
4850  *
4851  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
4852  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
4853  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
4854  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
4855  *
4856  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
4857  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
4858  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
4859  *
4860  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
4861  *	wake_tx_queue
4862  *
4863  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
4864  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
4865  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
4866  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
4867  *
4868  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
4869  *
4870  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
4871  *	device has
4872  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4873  *	supported by the driver for each vif
4874  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4875  *	supported by the driver for each peer
4876  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
4877  *	long/short retry configuration
4878  *
4879  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
4880  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
4881  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
4882  */
4883 struct wiphy {
4884 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
4885 
4886 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
4887 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
4888 
4889 	struct mac_address *addresses;
4890 
4891 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
4892 
4893 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
4894 	int n_iface_combinations;
4895 	u16 software_iftypes;
4896 
4897 	u16 n_addresses;
4898 
4899 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
4900 	u16 interface_modes;
4901 
4902 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
4903 
4904 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
4905 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
4906 
4907 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
4908 
4909 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
4910 
4911 	int bss_priv_size;
4912 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
4913 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
4914 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
4915 	u8 max_match_sets;
4916 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
4917 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
4918 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
4919 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
4920 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
4921 
4922 	int n_cipher_suites;
4923 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
4924 
4925 	int n_akm_suites;
4926 	const u32 *akm_suites;
4927 
4928 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
4929 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
4930 
4931 	u8 retry_short;
4932 	u8 retry_long;
4933 	u32 frag_threshold;
4934 	u32 rts_threshold;
4935 	u8 coverage_class;
4936 
4937 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
4938 	u32 hw_version;
4939 
4940 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4941 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
4942 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
4943 #endif
4944 
4945 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
4946 
4947 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
4948 
4949 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
4950 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
4951 
4952 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
4953 
4954 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
4955 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4956 
4957 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
4958 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
4959 
4960 	const void *privid;
4961 
4962 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
4963 
4964 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4965 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
4966 
4967 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
4968 
4969 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
4970 
4971 	struct device dev;
4972 
4973 	bool registered;
4974 
4975 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
4976 
4977 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
4978 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
4979 
4980 	struct list_head wdev_list;
4981 
4982 	possible_net_t _net;
4983 
4984 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
4985 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
4986 #endif
4987 
4988 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
4989 
4990 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
4991 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
4992 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
4993 
4994 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
4995 
4996 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
4997 
4998 	u32 bss_select_support;
4999 
5000 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5001 
5002 	u32 txq_limit;
5003 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5004 	u32 txq_quantum;
5005 
5006 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5007 
5008 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5009 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5010 
5011 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5012 
5013 	struct {
5014 		u64 peer, vif;
5015 		u8 max_retry;
5016 	} tid_config_support;
5017 
5018 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5019 
5020 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5021 };
5022 
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5023 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5024 {
5025 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5026 }
5027 
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5028 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5029 {
5030 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5031 }
5032 
5033 /**
5034  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5035  *
5036  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5037  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5038  */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5039 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5040 {
5041 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5042 	return &wiphy->priv;
5043 }
5044 
5045 /**
5046  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5047  *
5048  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5049  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5050  */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5051 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5052 {
5053 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5054 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5055 }
5056 
5057 /**
5058  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5059  *
5060  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5061  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5062  */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5063 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5064 {
5065 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5066 }
5067 
5068 /**
5069  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5070  *
5071  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5072  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5073  */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5074 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5075 {
5076 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5077 }
5078 
5079 /**
5080  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5081  *
5082  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5083  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5084  */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5085 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5086 {
5087 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5088 }
5089 
5090 /**
5091  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5092  *
5093  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5094  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5095  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5096  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5097  *
5098  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5099  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5100  *
5101  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5102  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5103  */
5104 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5105 			   const char *requested_name);
5106 
5107 /**
5108  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5109  *
5110  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5111  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5112  *
5113  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5114  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5115  *
5116  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5117  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5118  */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5119 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5120 				      int sizeof_priv)
5121 {
5122 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5123 }
5124 
5125 /**
5126  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5127  *
5128  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5129  *
5130  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5131  */
5132 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5133 
5134 /**
5135  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5136  *
5137  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5138  *
5139  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5140  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5141  * request that is being handled.
5142  */
5143 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5144 
5145 /**
5146  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5147  *
5148  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5149  */
5150 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5151 
5152 /* internal structs */
5153 struct cfg80211_conn;
5154 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5155 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5156 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5157 
5158 /**
5159  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
5160  *
5161  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
5162  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
5163  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
5164  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
5165  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device.
5166  *
5167  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
5168  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
5169  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
5170  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
5171  *
5172  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
5173  * @iftype: interface type
5174  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
5175  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
5176  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
5177  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
5178  * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5179  * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track
5180  *	the user-set channel definition.
5181  * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to
5182  *	track the channel to be used for AP later
5183  * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5184  * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5185  * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5186  * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5187  * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5188  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
5189  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
5190  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
5191  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
5192  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
5193  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
5194  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
5195  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
5196  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
5197  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
5198  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
5199  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
5200  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
5201  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
5202  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
5203  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
5204  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
5205  * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list
5206  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
5207  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
5208  * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers
5209  *	and some API functions require it held
5210  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
5211  *	beacons, 0 when not valid
5212  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
5213  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
5214  *	the P2P Device.
5215  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
5216  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
5217  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
5218  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
5219  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
5220  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
5221  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
5222  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
5223  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
5224  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
5225  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
5226  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
5227  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
5228  * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID
5229  * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel
5230  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
5231  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
5232  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
5233  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
5234  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
5235  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
5236  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
5237  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
5238  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
5239  *	unprotected beacon report
5240  */
5241 struct wireless_dev {
5242 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5243 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5244 
5245 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
5246 	struct list_head list;
5247 	struct net_device *netdev;
5248 
5249 	u32 identifier;
5250 
5251 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
5252 	spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock;
5253 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
5254 
5255 	struct mutex mtx;
5256 
5257 	bool use_4addr, is_running;
5258 
5259 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
5260 
5261 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
5262 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5263 	u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len;
5264 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
5265 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
5266 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
5267 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
5268 
5269 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
5270 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5271 
5272 	struct list_head event_list;
5273 	spinlock_t event_lock;
5274 
5275 	struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */
5276 	struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
5277 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
5278 
5279 	bool ibss_fixed;
5280 	bool ibss_dfs_possible;
5281 
5282 	bool ps;
5283 	int ps_timeout;
5284 
5285 	int beacon_interval;
5286 
5287 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
5288 
5289 	u32 owner_nlportid;
5290 	bool nl_owner_dead;
5291 
5292 	bool cac_started;
5293 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
5294 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
5295 
5296 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5297 	/* wext data */
5298 	struct {
5299 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
5300 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
5301 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
5302 		const u8 *ie;
5303 		size_t ie_len;
5304 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5305 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5306 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5307 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
5308 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
5309 	} wext;
5310 #endif
5311 
5312 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config;
5313 
5314 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
5315 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
5316 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
5317 
5318 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
5319 };
5320 
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)5321 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5322 {
5323 	if (wdev->netdev)
5324 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
5325 	return wdev->address;
5326 }
5327 
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)5328 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5329 {
5330 	if (wdev->netdev)
5331 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
5332 	return wdev->is_running;
5333 }
5334 
5335 /**
5336  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
5337  *
5338  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
5339  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
5340  */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)5341 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5342 {
5343 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
5344 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
5345 }
5346 
5347 /**
5348  * DOC: Utility functions
5349  *
5350  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
5351  */
5352 
5353 /**
5354  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
5355  *
5356  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
5357  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
5358  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
5359  */
5360 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)5361 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
5362 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
5363 {
5364 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
5365 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
5366 }
5367 
5368 /**
5369  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
5370  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
5371  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
5372  */
5373 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)5374 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5375 {
5376 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
5377 }
5378 
5379 /**
5380  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
5381  *
5382  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
5383  * @chan: channel
5384  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
5385  */
5386 enum nl80211_chan_width
5387 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
5388 
5389 /**
5390  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
5391  * @chan: channel number
5392  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5393  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5394  */
5395 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
5396 
5397 /**
5398  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
5399  * @chan: channel number
5400  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5401  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5402  */
5403 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)5404 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
5405 {
5406 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
5407 }
5408 
5409 /**
5410  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5411  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
5412  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5413  */
5414 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
5415 
5416 /**
5417  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5418  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
5419  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5420  */
5421 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)5422 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
5423 {
5424 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5425 }
5426 
5427 /**
5428  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
5429  * frequency
5430  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5431  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
5432  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5433  */
5434 struct ieee80211_channel *
5435 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
5436 
5437 /**
5438  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
5439  *
5440  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5441  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
5442  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5443  */
5444 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)5445 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
5446 {
5447 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5448 }
5449 
5450 /**
5451  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
5452  * @chan: control channel to check
5453  *
5454  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
5455  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
5456  */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)5457 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5458 {
5459 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
5460 		return false;
5461 
5462 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
5463 }
5464 
5465 /**
5466  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
5467  *
5468  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5469  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
5470  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
5471  *
5472  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
5473  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
5474  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
5475  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
5476  */
5477 struct ieee80211_rate *
5478 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5479 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
5480 
5481 /**
5482  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
5483  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5484  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
5485  *
5486  * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
5487  * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
5488  */
5489 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5490 			      enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width);
5491 
5492 /*
5493  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
5494  *
5495  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
5496  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
5497  */
5498 
5499 struct radiotap_align_size {
5500 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
5501 };
5502 
5503 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
5504 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
5505 	int n_bits;
5506 	uint32_t oui;
5507 	uint8_t subns;
5508 };
5509 
5510 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
5511 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
5512 	int n_ns;
5513 };
5514 
5515 /**
5516  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
5517  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
5518  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
5519  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
5520  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
5521  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
5522  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
5523  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
5524  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
5525  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
5526  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
5527  *	radiotap namespace or not
5528  *
5529  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
5530  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
5531  * @_arg_index: next argument index
5532  * @_arg: next argument pointer
5533  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
5534  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
5535  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
5536  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
5537  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
5538  *	next bitmap word
5539  *
5540  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
5541  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
5542  */
5543 
5544 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
5545 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
5546 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
5547 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
5548 
5549 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
5550 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
5551 
5552 	unsigned char *this_arg;
5553 	int this_arg_index;
5554 	int this_arg_size;
5555 
5556 	int is_radiotap_ns;
5557 
5558 	int _max_length;
5559 	int _arg_index;
5560 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
5561 	int _reset_on_ext;
5562 };
5563 
5564 int
5565 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
5566 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
5567 				 int max_length,
5568 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
5569 
5570 int
5571 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
5572 
5573 
5574 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
5575 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
5576 
5577 /**
5578  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
5579  *
5580  * @skb: the frame
5581  *
5582  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
5583  * returns the 802.11 header length.
5584  *
5585  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
5586  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
5587  * 802.11 header.
5588  */
5589 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
5590 
5591 /**
5592  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
5593  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
5594  * Return: The header length in bytes.
5595  */
5596 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
5597 
5598 /**
5599  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
5600  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
5601  *	(first byte) will be accessed
5602  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
5603  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
5604  */
5605 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
5606 
5607 /**
5608  * DOC: Data path helpers
5609  *
5610  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
5611  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
5612  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
5613  */
5614 
5615 /**
5616  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5617  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5618  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
5619  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
5620  * @addr: the device MAC address
5621  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5622  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
5623  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5624  */
5625 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
5626 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5627 				  u8 data_offset);
5628 
5629 /**
5630  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5631  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5632  * @addr: the device MAC address
5633  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5634  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5635  */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)5636 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
5637 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
5638 {
5639 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0);
5640 }
5641 
5642 /**
5643  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
5644  *
5645  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
5646  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
5647  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
5648  *
5649  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
5650  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
5651  *	initialized by the caller.
5652  * @addr: The device MAC address.
5653  * @iftype: The device interface type.
5654  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
5655  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5656  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5657  */
5658 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
5659 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5660 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
5661 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa);
5662 
5663 /**
5664  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
5665  * @skb: the data frame
5666  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
5667  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
5668  */
5669 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
5670 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
5671 
5672 /**
5673  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
5674  *
5675  * @eid: element ID
5676  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5677  * @len: length of data
5678  * @match: byte array to match
5679  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5680  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
5681  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
5682  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
5683  *	the data portion instead.
5684  *
5685  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5686  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5687  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5688  * requested element struct.
5689  *
5690  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5691  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5692  * byte array to match.
5693  */
5694 const struct element *
5695 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5696 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5697 			 unsigned int match_offset);
5698 
5699 /**
5700  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
5701  *
5702  * @eid: element ID
5703  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5704  * @len: length of data
5705  * @match: byte array to match
5706  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5707  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
5708  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
5709  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
5710  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
5711  *	the second byte is the IE length.
5712  *
5713  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5714  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5715  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
5716  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5717  * element ID.
5718  *
5719  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5720  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5721  * byte array to match.
5722  */
5723 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)5724 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5725 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5726 		       unsigned int match_offset)
5727 {
5728 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
5729 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
5730 	 */
5731 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
5732 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
5733 		return NULL;
5734 
5735 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
5736 						match, match_len,
5737 						match_offset ?
5738 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
5739 }
5740 
5741 /**
5742  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
5743  *
5744  * @eid: element ID
5745  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5746  * @len: length of data
5747  *
5748  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5749  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5750  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5751  * requested element struct.
5752  *
5753  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5754  * having to fit into the given data.
5755  */
5756 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)5757 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5758 {
5759 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5760 }
5761 
5762 /**
5763  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
5764  *
5765  * @eid: element ID
5766  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5767  * @len: length of data
5768  *
5769  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5770  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5771  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5772  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5773  *
5774  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5775  * having to fit into the given data.
5776  */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)5777 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5778 {
5779 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5780 }
5781 
5782 /**
5783  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
5784  *
5785  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5786  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5787  * @len: length of data
5788  *
5789  * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if
5790  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5791  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5792  * requested element struct.
5793  *
5794  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5795  * having to fit into the given data.
5796  */
5797 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)5798 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5799 {
5800 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5801 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
5802 }
5803 
5804 /**
5805  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
5806  *
5807  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5808  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5809  * @len: length of data
5810  *
5811  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
5812  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5813  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5814  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5815  *
5816  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5817  * having to fit into the given data.
5818  */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)5819 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5820 {
5821 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5822 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
5823 }
5824 
5825 /**
5826  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
5827  *
5828  * @oui: vendor OUI
5829  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5830  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5831  * @len: length of data
5832  *
5833  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5834  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
5835  * return the element structure for the requested element.
5836  *
5837  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5838  * the given data.
5839  */
5840 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5841 						const u8 *ies,
5842 						unsigned int len);
5843 
5844 /**
5845  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
5846  *
5847  * @oui: vendor OUI
5848  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5849  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5850  * @len: length of data
5851  *
5852  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5853  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
5854  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5855  * element ID.
5856  *
5857  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5858  * the given data.
5859  */
5860 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)5861 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5862 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
5863 {
5864 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
5865 }
5866 
5867 /**
5868  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
5869  *
5870  * @dev: network device
5871  * @addr: STA MAC address
5872  *
5873  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
5874  * devices upon STA association.
5875  */
5876 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
5877 
5878 /**
5879  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
5880  *
5881  * TODO
5882  */
5883 
5884 /**
5885  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
5886  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
5887  *	conflicts)
5888  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
5889  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
5890  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
5891  *	alpha2.
5892  *
5893  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
5894  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
5895  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
5896  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
5897  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
5898  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
5899  *
5900  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
5901  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
5902  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
5903  *
5904  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
5905  * an -ENOMEM.
5906  *
5907  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
5908  */
5909 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
5910 
5911 /**
5912  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
5913  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5914  * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy
5915  *
5916  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
5917  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
5918  * information.
5919  *
5920  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
5921  */
5922 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5923 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
5924 
5925 /**
5926  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl - set regdom for self-managed drivers
5927  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5928  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
5929  *
5930  * This functions requires the RTNL to be held and applies the new regdomain
5931  * synchronously to this wiphy. For more details see
5932  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
5933  *
5934  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
5935  */
5936 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5937 					struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
5938 
5939 /**
5940  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
5941  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5942  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
5943  *
5944  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
5945  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
5946  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
5947  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
5948  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
5949  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
5950  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
5951  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
5952  * that called this helper.
5953  */
5954 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5955 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
5956 
5957 /**
5958  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
5959  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
5960  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
5961  *
5962  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
5963  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
5964  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
5965  * and processed already.
5966  *
5967  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
5968  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
5969  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
5970  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
5971  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
5972  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
5973  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
5974  */
5975 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5976 					       u32 center_freq);
5977 
5978 /**
5979  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
5980  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
5981  *
5982  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
5983  * proper string representation.
5984  */
5985 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
5986 
5987 /**
5988  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
5989  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
5990  *
5991  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
5992  */
5993 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5994 
5995 /**
5996  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
5997  *
5998  */
5999 
6000 /**
6001  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
6002  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
6003  *
6004  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
6005  * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried.
6006  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
6007  *
6008  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
6009  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
6010  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
6011  *
6012  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6013  * an -ENODATA.
6014  *
6015  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
6016  */
6017 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
6018 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
6019 
6020 /*
6021  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
6022  * functions and BSS handling helpers
6023  */
6024 
6025 /**
6026  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
6027  *
6028  * @request: the corresponding scan request
6029  * @info: information about the completed scan
6030  */
6031 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
6032 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6033 
6034 /**
6035  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
6036  *
6037  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
6038  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6039  */
6040 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6041 
6042 /**
6043  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6044  *
6045  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6046  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6047  *
6048  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6049  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6050  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6051  */
6052 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6053 
6054 /**
6055  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6056  *
6057  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6058  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6059  *
6060  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6061  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6062  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6063  * This function should be called with rtnl locked.
6064  */
6065 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6066 
6067 /**
6068  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
6069  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6070  * @data: the BSS metadata
6071  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
6072  * @len: length of the management frame
6073  * @gfp: context flags
6074  *
6075  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6076  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6077  *
6078  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6079  * Or %NULL on error.
6080  */
6081 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6082 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6083 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6084 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6085 			       gfp_t gfp);
6086 
6087 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6088 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6089 				struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6090 				enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6091 				struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6092 				s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6093 {
6094 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6095 		.chan = rx_channel,
6096 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6097 		.signal = signal,
6098 	};
6099 
6100 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6101 }
6102 
6103 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6104 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6105 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6106 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6107 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6108 {
6109 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6110 		.chan = rx_channel,
6111 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6112 		.signal = signal,
6113 	};
6114 
6115 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6116 }
6117 
6118 /**
6119  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
6120  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
6121  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
6122  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
6123  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
6124  */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)6125 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
6126 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
6127 {
6128 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
6129 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
6130 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
6131 
6132 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
6133 
6134 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
6135 
6136 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
6137 }
6138 
6139 /**
6140  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
6141  * @element: element to check
6142  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
6143  */
6144 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
6145 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
6146 
6147 /**
6148  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
6149  * @ie: ies
6150  * @ielen: length of IEs
6151  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
6152  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
6153  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
6154  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
6155  */
6156 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6157 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
6158 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
6159 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
6160 
6161 /**
6162  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
6163  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
6164  *	from a beacon or probe response
6165  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
6166  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
6167  */
6168 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
6169 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
6170 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
6171 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
6172 };
6173 
6174 /**
6175  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
6176  *
6177  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6178  * @data: the BSS metadata
6179  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
6180  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
6181  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
6182  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
6183  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
6184  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
6185  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
6186  * @gfp: context flags
6187  *
6188  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6189  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6190  *
6191  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6192  * Or %NULL on error.
6193  */
6194 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6195 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6196 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6197 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6198 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6199 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6200 			 gfp_t gfp);
6201 
6202 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6203 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6204 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6205 			  enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6206 			  enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6207 			  const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6208 			  u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6209 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6210 {
6211 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6212 		.chan = rx_channel,
6213 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6214 		.signal = signal,
6215 	};
6216 
6217 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6218 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6219 					gfp);
6220 }
6221 
6222 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6223 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6224 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6225 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6226 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6227 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6228 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6229 {
6230 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6231 		.chan = rx_channel,
6232 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6233 		.signal = signal,
6234 	};
6235 
6236 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6237 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6238 					gfp);
6239 }
6240 
6241 /**
6242  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
6243  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6244  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
6245  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
6246  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
6247  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
6248  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
6249  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
6250  */
6251 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6252 				      struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6253 				      const u8 *bssid,
6254 				      const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
6255 				      enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
6256 				      enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
6257 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)6258 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6259 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6260 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
6261 {
6262 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
6263 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
6264 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
6265 }
6266 
6267 /**
6268  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
6269  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6270  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
6271  *
6272  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6273  */
6274 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6275 
6276 /**
6277  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
6278  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6279  * @bss: the BSS struct
6280  *
6281  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6282  */
6283 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6284 
6285 /**
6286  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
6287  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6288  * @bss: the bss to remove
6289  *
6290  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
6291  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
6292  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
6293  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
6294  */
6295 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6296 
6297 /**
6298  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
6299  *
6300  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
6301  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
6302  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
6303  *
6304  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6305  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
6306  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
6307  * @iter: the iterator function to call
6308  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
6309  */
6310 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6311 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6312 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6313 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6314 				    void *data),
6315 		       void *iter_data);
6316 
6317 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width
cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)6318 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
6319 {
6320 	switch (chandef->width) {
6321 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
6322 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5;
6323 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
6324 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10;
6325 	default:
6326 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6327 	}
6328 }
6329 
6330 /**
6331  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
6332  * @dev: network device
6333  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
6334  * @len: length of the frame data
6335  *
6336  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
6337  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
6338  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
6339  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6340  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6341  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6342  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
6343  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
6344  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
6345  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
6346  *
6347  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6348  */
6349 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6350 
6351 /**
6352  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
6353  * @dev: network device
6354  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
6355  *
6356  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
6357  * mutex.
6358  */
6359 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6360 
6361 /**
6362  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
6363  * @dev: network device
6364  * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
6365  *	moves to cfg80211 in this call
6366  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
6367  * @len: length of the frame data
6368  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
6369  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
6370  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
6371  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
6372  *
6373  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6374  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6375  *
6376  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6377  */
6378 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
6379 			    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6380 			    const u8 *buf, size_t len,
6381 			    int uapsd_queues,
6382 			    const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len);
6383 
6384 /**
6385  * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association
6386  * @dev: network device
6387  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out.
6388  *
6389  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6390  */
6391 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6392 
6393 /**
6394  * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt
6395  * @dev: network device
6396  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned.
6397  *
6398  * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX,
6399  * an association attempt was abandoned.
6400  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6401  */
6402 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6403 
6404 /**
6405  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
6406  * @dev: network device
6407  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
6408  * @len: length of the frame data
6409  *
6410  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
6411  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
6412  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
6413  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
6414  */
6415 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6416 
6417 /**
6418  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
6419  * @dev: network device
6420  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
6421  * @len: length of the frame data
6422  *
6423  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
6424  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
6425  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
6426  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
6427  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
6428  *
6429  * This function may sleep.
6430  */
6431 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
6432 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6433 
6434 /**
6435  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
6436  * @dev: network device
6437  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
6438  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
6439  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
6440  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
6441  * @gfp: allocation flags
6442  *
6443  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
6444  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
6445  * primitive.
6446  */
6447 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
6448 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
6449 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
6450 
6451 /**
6452  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
6453  *
6454  * @dev: network device
6455  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
6456  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
6457  * @gfp: allocation flags
6458  *
6459  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
6460  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
6461  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
6462  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
6463  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
6464  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
6465  */
6466 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6467 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
6468 
6469 /**
6470  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
6471  * 					candidate
6472  *
6473  * @dev: network device
6474  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
6475  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
6476  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
6477  * @gfp: allocation flags
6478  *
6479  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
6480  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
6481  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
6482  */
6483 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
6484 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
6485 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
6486 
6487 /**
6488  * DOC: RFkill integration
6489  *
6490  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
6491  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
6492  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
6493  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
6494  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
6495  *
6496  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
6497  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
6498  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
6499  */
6500 
6501 /**
6502  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
6503  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6504  * @blocked: block status
6505  */
6506 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked);
6507 
6508 /**
6509  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
6510  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6511  */
6512 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6513 
6514 /**
6515  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
6516  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6517  */
6518 void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6519 
6520 /**
6521  * DOC: Vendor commands
6522  *
6523  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
6524  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
6525  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
6526  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
6527  * the configuration mechanism.
6528  *
6529  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
6530  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
6531  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
6532  *
6533  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
6534  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
6535  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
6536  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
6537  * managers etc. need.
6538  */
6539 
6540 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6541 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6542 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6543 					   int approxlen);
6544 
6545 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6546 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6547 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6548 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6549 					   unsigned int portid,
6550 					   int vendor_event_idx,
6551 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
6552 
6553 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
6554 
6555 /**
6556  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
6557  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6558  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6559  *	be put into the skb
6560  *
6561  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6562  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6563  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
6564  *
6565  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
6566  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6567  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6568  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6569  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6570  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
6571  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
6572  *
6573  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
6574  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
6575  *
6576  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6577  */
6578 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)6579 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6580 {
6581 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6582 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
6583 }
6584 
6585 /**
6586  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
6587  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6588  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
6589  *
6590  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6591  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
6592  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
6593  * skb regardless of the return value.
6594  *
6595  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6596  */
6597 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
6598 
6599 /**
6600  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender
6601  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6602  *
6603  * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
6604  * Valid to call only there.
6605  */
6606 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6607 
6608 /**
6609  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
6610  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6611  * @wdev: the wireless device
6612  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6613  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6614  *	be put into the skb
6615  * @gfp: allocation flags
6616  *
6617  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6618  * vendor-specific multicast group.
6619  *
6620  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6621  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6622  * attribute.
6623  *
6624  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6625  * skb to send the event.
6626  *
6627  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6628  */
6629 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)6630 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6631 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6632 {
6633 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6634 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6635 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6636 }
6637 
6638 /**
6639  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
6640  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6641  * @wdev: the wireless device
6642  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6643  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
6644  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6645  *	be put into the skb
6646  * @gfp: allocation flags
6647  *
6648  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
6649  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
6650  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
6651  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
6652  *
6653  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6654  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6655  * attribute.
6656  *
6657  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6658  * skb to send the event.
6659  *
6660  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6661  */
6662 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)6663 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6664 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6665 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
6666 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6667 {
6668 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6669 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6670 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6671 }
6672 
6673 /**
6674  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
6675  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
6676  * @gfp: allocation flags
6677  *
6678  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6679  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
6680  */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)6681 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6682 {
6683 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6684 }
6685 
6686 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
6687 /**
6688  * DOC: Test mode
6689  *
6690  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
6691  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
6692  * factory programming.
6693  *
6694  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
6695  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
6696  */
6697 
6698 /**
6699  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
6700  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6701  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6702  *	be put into the skb
6703  *
6704  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6705  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6706  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
6707  *
6708  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
6709  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6710  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6711  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6712  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6713  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
6714  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
6715  *
6716  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
6717  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
6718  *
6719  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6720  */
6721 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)6722 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6723 {
6724 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6725 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
6726 }
6727 
6728 /**
6729  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
6730  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6731  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
6732  *
6733  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6734  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
6735  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
6736  * regardless of the return value.
6737  *
6738  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6739  */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)6740 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
6741 {
6742 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
6743 }
6744 
6745 /**
6746  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
6747  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6748  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6749  *	be put into the skb
6750  * @gfp: allocation flags
6751  *
6752  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6753  * testmode multicast group.
6754  *
6755  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
6756  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
6757  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
6758  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
6759  * in any other way.
6760  *
6761  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
6762  * skb to send the event.
6763  *
6764  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6765  */
6766 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)6767 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
6768 {
6769 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6770 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
6771 					  approxlen, gfp);
6772 }
6773 
6774 /**
6775  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
6776  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6777  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
6778  * @gfp: allocation flags
6779  *
6780  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6781  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
6782  * consumes it.
6783  */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)6784 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6785 {
6786 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6787 }
6788 
6789 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
6790 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
6791 #else
6792 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
6793 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
6794 #endif
6795 
6796 /**
6797  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
6798  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
6799  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
6800  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
6801  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
6802  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
6803  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
6804  *	status for a FILS connection.
6805  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6806  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
6807  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
6808  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6809  */
6810 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
6811 	const u8 *kek;
6812 	size_t kek_len;
6813 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
6814 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
6815 	const u8 *pmk;
6816 	size_t pmk_len;
6817 	const u8 *pmkid;
6818 };
6819 
6820 /**
6821  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
6822  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6823  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6824  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6825  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6826  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6827  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6828  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6829  *	case.
6830  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL)
6831  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6832  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6833  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6834  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6835  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6836  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6837  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
6838  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
6839  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6840  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
6841  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
6842  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
6843  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
6844  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
6845  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
6846  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
6847  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
6848  */
6849 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
6850 	int status;
6851 	const u8 *bssid;
6852 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
6853 	const u8 *req_ie;
6854 	size_t req_ie_len;
6855 	const u8 *resp_ie;
6856 	size_t resp_ie_len;
6857 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
6858 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
6859 };
6860 
6861 /**
6862  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6863  *
6864  * @dev: network device
6865  * @params: connection response parameters
6866  * @gfp: allocation flags
6867  *
6868  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6869  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6870  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
6871  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
6872  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
6873  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6874  */
6875 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
6876 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
6877 			   gfp_t gfp);
6878 
6879 /**
6880  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6881  *
6882  * @dev: network device
6883  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6884  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6885  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6886  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6887  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6888  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6889  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6890  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6891  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6892  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6893  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6894  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6895  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6896  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6897  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6898  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6899  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6900  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6901  *	case.
6902  * @gfp: allocation flags
6903  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
6904  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
6905  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
6906  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
6907  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
6908  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
6909  *
6910  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6911  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6912  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
6913  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
6914  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6915  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6916  */
6917 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)6918 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6919 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
6920 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
6921 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
6922 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
6923 {
6924 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
6925 
6926 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
6927 	params.status = status;
6928 	params.bssid = bssid;
6929 	params.bss = bss;
6930 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
6931 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
6932 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
6933 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
6934 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
6935 
6936 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
6937 }
6938 
6939 /**
6940  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6941  *
6942  * @dev: network device
6943  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6944  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6945  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6946  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6947  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6948  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6949  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6950  *	the real status code for failures.
6951  * @gfp: allocation flags
6952  *
6953  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6954  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6955  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
6956  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6957  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6958  */
6959 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)6960 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6961 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
6962 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
6963 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
6964 {
6965 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
6966 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
6967 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
6968 }
6969 
6970 /**
6971  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
6972  *
6973  * @dev: network device
6974  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6975  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6976  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6977  * @gfp: allocation flags
6978  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
6979  *
6980  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
6981  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
6982  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
6983  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
6984  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
6985  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6986  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6987  */
6988 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)6989 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6990 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
6991 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
6992 {
6993 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
6994 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
6995 }
6996 
6997 /**
6998  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
6999  *
7000  * @channel: the channel of the new AP
7001  * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set)
7002  * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set)
7003  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7004  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7005  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7006  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7007  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
7008  */
7009 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
7010 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
7011 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7012 	const u8 *bssid;
7013 	const u8 *req_ie;
7014 	size_t req_ie_len;
7015 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7016 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7017 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7018 };
7019 
7020 /**
7021  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
7022  *
7023  * @dev: network device
7024  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
7025  * @gfp: allocation flags
7026  *
7027  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
7028  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
7029  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
7030  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
7031  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
7032  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
7033  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
7034  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
7035  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
7036  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
7037  */
7038 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
7039 		     gfp_t gfp);
7040 
7041 /**
7042  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
7043  *
7044  * @dev: network device
7045  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7046  * @gfp: allocation flags
7047  *
7048  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
7049  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
7050  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
7051  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
7052  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
7053  * indicate the 802.11 association.
7054  */
7055 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7056 			      gfp_t gfp);
7057 
7058 /**
7059  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
7060  *
7061  * @dev: network device
7062  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
7063  * @ie_len: length of IEs
7064  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
7065  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
7066  * @gfp: allocation flags
7067  *
7068  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
7069  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
7070  */
7071 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
7072 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
7073 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
7074 
7075 /**
7076  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
7077  * @wdev: wireless device
7078  * @cookie: the request cookie
7079  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7080  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
7081  *	channel
7082  * @gfp: allocation flags
7083  */
7084 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7085 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7086 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
7087 
7088 /**
7089  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7090  * @wdev: wireless device
7091  * @cookie: the request cookie
7092  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7093  * @gfp: allocation flags
7094  */
7095 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7096 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7097 					gfp_t gfp);
7098 
7099 /**
7100  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
7101  * @wdev: wireless device
7102  * @cookie: the requested cookie
7103  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
7104  * @gfp: allocation flags
7105  */
7106 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7107 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
7108 
7109 /**
7110  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
7111  *
7112  * @sinfo: the station information
7113  * @gfp: allocation flags
7114  */
7115 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7116 
7117 /**
7118  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
7119  * @sinfo: the station information
7120  *
7121  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
7122  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
7123  * the stack.)
7124  */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)7125 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
7126 {
7127 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
7128 }
7129 
7130 /**
7131  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
7132  *
7133  * @dev: the netdev
7134  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7135  * @sinfo: the station information
7136  * @gfp: allocation flags
7137  */
7138 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7139 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7140 
7141 /**
7142  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7143  * @dev: the netdev
7144  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7145  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
7146  * @gfp: allocation flags
7147  */
7148 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7149 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7150 
7151 /**
7152  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7153  *
7154  * @dev: the netdev
7155  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7156  * @gfp: allocation flags
7157  */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)7158 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
7159 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
7160 {
7161 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
7162 }
7163 
7164 /**
7165  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
7166  *
7167  * @dev: the netdev
7168  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7169  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
7170  * @gfp: allocation flags
7171  *
7172  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
7173  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
7174  * for some reasons, this function is called.
7175  *
7176  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
7177  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
7178  */
7179 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7180 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
7181 			  gfp_t gfp);
7182 
7183 /**
7184  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7185  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7186  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
7187  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7188  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7189  * @len: length of the frame data
7190  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7191  *
7192  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7193  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7194  *
7195  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7196  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7197  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7198  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7199  */
7200 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm,
7201 			  const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags);
7202 
7203 /**
7204  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7205  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7206  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
7207  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7208  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7209  * @len: length of the frame data
7210  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7211  *
7212  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7213  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7214  *
7215  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7216  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7217  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7218  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7219  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)7220 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
7221 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7222 				    u32 flags)
7223 {
7224 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len,
7225 				    flags);
7226 }
7227 
7228 /**
7229  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
7230  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7231  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
7232  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7233  * @len: length of the frame data
7234  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7235  * @gfp: context flags
7236  *
7237  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
7238  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
7239  * transmission attempt.
7240  */
7241 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7242 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp);
7243 
7244 /**
7245  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
7246  *                                   port frames
7247  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7248  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
7249  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
7250  * @len: length of the frame data
7251  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7252  * @gfp: context flags
7253  *
7254  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
7255  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
7256  * the transmission attempt.
7257  */
7258 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7259 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
7260 				     gfp_t gfp);
7261 
7262 /**
7263  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
7264  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7265  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
7266  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
7267  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
7268  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
7269  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
7270  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
7271  *
7272  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
7273  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
7274  * control port frames over nl80211.
7275  *
7276  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
7277  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
7278  *
7279  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
7280  */
7281 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev,
7282 			      struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted);
7283 
7284 /**
7285  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
7286  * @dev: network device
7287  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
7288  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
7289  * @gfp: context flags
7290  *
7291  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
7292  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
7293  */
7294 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7295 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
7296 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
7297 
7298 /**
7299  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
7300  * @dev: network device
7301  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7302  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
7303  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
7304  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
7305  * @gfp: context flags
7306  */
7307 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7308 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
7309 
7310 /**
7311  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
7312  * @dev: network device
7313  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7314  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
7315  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
7316  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
7317  * @gfp: context flags
7318  *
7319  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
7320  * given interval is exceeded.
7321  */
7322 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7323 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
7324 
7325 /**
7326  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
7327  * @dev: network device
7328  * @gfp: context flags
7329  *
7330  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
7331  */
7332 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
7333 
7334 /**
7335  * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
7336  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7337  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7338  * @gfp: context flags
7339  *
7340  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
7341  */
7342 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7343 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp);
7344 
7345 /**
7346  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
7347  * @dev: network device
7348  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
7349  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
7350  * @gfp: context flags
7351  *
7352  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
7353  * frame.
7354  */
7355 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
7356 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
7357 				       gfp_t gfp);
7358 
7359 /**
7360  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
7361  * @netdev: network device
7362  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7363  * @event: type of event
7364  * @gfp: context flags
7365  *
7366  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
7367  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
7368  * also by full-MAC drivers.
7369  */
7370 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7371 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7372 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
7373 
7374 
7375 /**
7376  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
7377  * @dev: network device
7378  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
7379  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
7380  * @gfp: allocation flags
7381  */
7382 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7383 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
7384 
7385 /**
7386  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
7387  * @dev: network device
7388  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
7389  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
7390  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
7391  * @gfp: allocation flags
7392  */
7393 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
7394 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
7395 
7396 /**
7397  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
7398  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7399  * @addr: the transmitter address
7400  * @gfp: context flags
7401  *
7402  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7403  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
7404  * sender.
7405  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7406  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7407  */
7408 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7409 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7410 
7411 /**
7412  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
7413  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7414  * @addr: the transmitter address
7415  * @gfp: context flags
7416  *
7417  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7418  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
7419  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
7420  * station to avoid event flooding.
7421  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7422  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7423  */
7424 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7425 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7426 
7427 /**
7428  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
7429  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
7430  * @addr: the address of the peer
7431  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
7432  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
7433  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
7434  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
7435  * @gfp: allocation flags
7436  */
7437 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7438 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
7439 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
7440 
7441 /**
7442  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
7443  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7444  * @frame: the frame
7445  * @len: length of the frame
7446  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
7447  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7448  *
7449  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7450  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7451  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7452  */
7453 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
7454 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
7455 
7456 /**
7457  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
7458  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7459  * @frame: the frame
7460  * @len: length of the frame
7461  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
7462  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7463  *
7464  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7465  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7466  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7467  */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)7468 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7469 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
7470 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
7471 {
7472 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
7473 					sig_dbm);
7474 }
7475 
7476 /**
7477  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
7478  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7479  * @chandef: the channel definition
7480  * @iftype: interface type
7481  *
7482  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7483  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
7484  */
7485 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7486 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7487 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7488 
7489 /**
7490  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
7491  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7492  * @chandef: the channel definition
7493  * @iftype: interface type
7494  *
7495  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7496  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
7497  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
7498  * more permissive conditions.
7499  *
7500  * Requires the RTNL to be held.
7501  */
7502 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7503 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7504 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7505 
7506 /*
7507  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
7508  * @dev: the device which switched channels
7509  * @chandef: the new channel definition
7510  *
7511  * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable
7512  * driver context!
7513  */
7514 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7515 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
7516 
7517 /*
7518  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
7519  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
7520  * @chandef: the future channel definition
7521  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
7522  *
7523  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
7524  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
7525  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
7526  */
7527 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7528 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7529 				       u8 count);
7530 
7531 /**
7532  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
7533  *
7534  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
7535  * @band: band pointer to fill
7536  *
7537  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7538  */
7539 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
7540 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
7541 
7542 /**
7543  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
7544  *
7545  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7546  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
7547  *
7548  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7549  */
7550 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7551 					  u8 *op_class);
7552 
7553 /**
7554  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
7555  *
7556  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7557  *
7558  * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
7559  */
7560 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)7561 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
7562 {
7563 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
7564 }
7565 
7566 /*
7567  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
7568  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
7569  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
7570  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
7571  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
7572  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
7573  * @gfp: allocation flags
7574  *
7575  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
7576  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
7577  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
7578  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
7579  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
7580  */
7581 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7582 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7583 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7584 
7585 /*
7586  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
7587  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
7588  *
7589  * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
7590  */
7591 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
7592 
7593 /**
7594  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
7595  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
7596  *
7597  * Call this function only for wdevs that have no netdev assigned,
7598  * e.g. P2P Devices. It removes the device from the list so that
7599  * it can no longer be used. It is necessary to call this function
7600  * even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the interface by
7601  * calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also
7602  * be called when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g.
7603  * when the device is unbound from the driver.
7604  *
7605  * Requires the RTNL to be held.
7606  */
7607 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
7608 
7609 /**
7610  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
7611  * @ies: FT IEs
7612  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
7613  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
7614  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
7615  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
7616  */
7617 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
7618 	const u8 *ies;
7619 	size_t ies_len;
7620 	const u8 *target_ap;
7621 	const u8 *ric_ies;
7622 	size_t ric_ies_len;
7623 };
7624 
7625 /**
7626  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
7627  * @netdev: network device
7628  * @ft_event: IE information
7629  */
7630 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7631 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
7632 
7633 /**
7634  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
7635  * @ies: the input IE buffer
7636  * @len: the input length
7637  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
7638  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
7639  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
7640  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
7641  *
7642  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
7643  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
7644  *
7645  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
7646  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
7647  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
7648  */
7649 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
7650 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
7651 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
7652 
7653 /**
7654  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
7655  * @ies: the IE buffer
7656  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7657  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7658  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7659  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7660  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7661  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
7662  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
7663  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7664  *
7665  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7666  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7667  * split.
7668  *
7669  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7670  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7671  *
7672  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7673  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7674  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7675  *
7676  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7677  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7678  * of the buffer should be used.
7679  */
7680 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7681 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
7682 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
7683 			      size_t offset);
7684 
7685 /**
7686  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
7687  * @ies: the IE buffer
7688  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7689  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7690  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7691  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7692  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7693  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7694  *
7695  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7696  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7697  * split.
7698  *
7699  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7700  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7701  *
7702  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7703  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7704  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7705  *
7706  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7707  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7708  * of the buffer should be used.
7709  */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)7710 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7711 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
7712 {
7713 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
7714 }
7715 
7716 /**
7717  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
7718  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
7719  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
7720  * @gfp: allocation flags
7721  *
7722  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
7723  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
7724  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
7725  * else caused the wakeup.
7726  */
7727 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7728 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7729 				   gfp_t gfp);
7730 
7731 /**
7732  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
7733  *
7734  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
7735  * @gfp: allocation flags
7736  *
7737  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
7738  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
7739  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
7740  */
7741 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
7742 
7743 /**
7744  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
7745  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7746  *
7747  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
7748  */
7749 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7750 
7751 /**
7752  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
7753  *
7754  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7755  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7756  *
7757  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
7758  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
7759  * the interface combinations.
7760  */
7761 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7762 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
7763 
7764 /**
7765  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
7766  *
7767  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7768  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7769  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
7770  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
7771  *
7772  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
7773  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
7774  * purposes.
7775  */
7776 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7777 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
7778 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
7779 					    void *data),
7780 			       void *data);
7781 
7782 /*
7783  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
7784  *
7785  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7786  * @wdev: wireless device
7787  * @gfp: context flags
7788  *
7789  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
7790  * disconnected.
7791  *
7792  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
7793  */
7794 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7795 			 gfp_t gfp);
7796 
7797 /**
7798  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
7799  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
7800  *
7801  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
7802  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
7803  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
7804  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
7805  *
7806  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
7807  * the driver while the function is running.
7808  */
7809 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7810 
7811 /**
7812  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
7813  *
7814  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
7815  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
7816  *
7817  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
7818  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
7819  */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)7820 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7821 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
7822 {
7823 	u8 *ft_byte;
7824 
7825 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
7826 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
7827 }
7828 
7829 /**
7830  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
7831  *
7832  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
7833  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
7834  *
7835  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
7836  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
7837  */
7838 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)7839 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7840 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
7841 {
7842 	u8 ft_byte;
7843 
7844 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
7845 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
7846 }
7847 
7848 /**
7849  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
7850  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
7851  *
7852  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
7853  */
7854 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
7855 
7856 /**
7857  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
7858  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
7859  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
7860  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
7861  *	 result.
7862  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
7863  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7864  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
7865  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
7866  * @info_len: the length of the &info
7867  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
7868  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
7869  */
7870 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
7871 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
7872 	u8 inst_id;
7873 	u8 peer_inst_id;
7874 	const u8 *addr;
7875 	u8 info_len;
7876 	const u8 *info;
7877 	u64 cookie;
7878 };
7879 
7880 /**
7881  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
7882  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
7883  * @match: match notification parameters
7884  * @gfp: allocation flags
7885  *
7886  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
7887  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
7888  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
7889  */
7890 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7891 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
7892 
7893 /**
7894  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7895  *
7896  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
7897  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7898  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7899  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
7900  * @gfp: allocation flags
7901  *
7902  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
7903  */
7904 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7905 				  u8 inst_id,
7906 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7907 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
7908 
7909 /* ethtool helper */
7910 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
7911 
7912 /**
7913  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
7914  * @netdev: network device
7915  * @params: External authentication parameters
7916  * @gfp: allocation flags
7917  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
7918  */
7919 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
7920 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
7921 				   gfp_t gfp);
7922 
7923 /**
7924  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
7925  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
7926  * @req: the original measurement request
7927  * @result: the result data
7928  * @gfp: allocation flags
7929  */
7930 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7931 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
7932 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
7933 			  gfp_t gfp);
7934 
7935 /**
7936  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
7937  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
7938  * @req: the original measurement request
7939  * @gfp: allocation flags
7940  *
7941  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
7942  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
7943  */
7944 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7945 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
7946 			    gfp_t gfp);
7947 
7948 /**
7949  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
7950  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7951  * @iftype: interface type
7952  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
7953  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
7954  *
7955  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
7956  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
7957  * check_swif is '1'.
7958  */
7959 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
7960 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
7961 
7962 
7963 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
7964 
7965 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
7966 
7967 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
7968 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7969 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7970 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7971 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7972 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7973 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7974 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7975 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7976 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7977 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7978 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7979 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7980 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7981 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7982 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7983 
7984 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
7985 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7986 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
7987 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7988 
7989 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7990 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
7991 
7992 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7993 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7994 
7995 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
7996 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
7997 #else
7998 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
7999 ({									\
8000 	if (0)								\
8001 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
8002 	0;								\
8003 })
8004 #endif
8005 
8006 /*
8007  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
8008  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
8009  * file/line information and a backtrace.
8010  */
8011 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8012 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
8013 
8014 /**
8015  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
8016  * @netdev: network device
8017  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
8018  * @gfp: allocation flags
8019  */
8020 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8021 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
8022 				    gfp_t gfp);
8023 
8024 /**
8025  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
8026  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8027  */
8028 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8029 
8030 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
8031